MR-E-A-QW003 MR-E - AG-QW003: General-Purpose AC Servo Ezmotion Mr-E Super General-Purpose Interface
MR-E-A-QW003 MR-E - AG-QW003: General-Purpose AC Servo Ezmotion Mr-E Super General-Purpose Interface
MR-E-A-QW003 MR-E - AG-QW003: General-Purpose AC Servo Ezmotion Mr-E Super General-Purpose Interface
MODEL
Safety Instructions
(Always read these instructions before using the equipment.) Do not attempt to install, operate, maintain or inspect the servo amplifier and servo motor until you have read through this Instruction Manual, Installation guide, Servo motor Instruction Manual and appended documents carefully and can use the equipment correctly. Do not use the servo amplifier and servo motor until you have a full knowledge of the equipment, safety information and instructions. In this Instruction Manual, the safety instruction levels are classified into "WARNING" and "CAUTION".
WARNING CAUTION
Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous conditions, resulting in death or severe injury. Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous conditions, resulting in medium or slight injury to personnel or may cause physical damage.
Note that the CAUTION level may lead to a serious consequence according to conditions. Please follow the instructions of both levels because they are important to personnel safety. What must not be done and what must be done are indicated by the following diagrammatic symbols. : Indicates what must not be done. For example, "No Fire" is indicated by : Indicates what must be done. For example, grounding is indicated by . .
In this Instruction Manual, instructions at a lower level than the above, instructions for other functions, and so on are classified into "POINT". After reading this installation guide, always keep it accessible to the operator.
A- 1
WARNING
Before wiring or inspection, turn off the power and wait for 15 minutes or more until the charge lamp turns off. Otherwise, an electric shock may occur. In addition, always confirm from the front of the servo amplifier, whether the charge lamp is off or not. Connect the servo amplifier and servo motor to ground. Any person who is involved in wiring and inspection should be fully competent to do the work. Do not attempt to wire the servo amplifier and servo motor until they have been installed. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock. Operate the switches with dry hand to prevent an electric shock. The cables should not be damaged, stressed, loaded, or pinched. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock.
CAUTION
Install the servo amplifier, servo motor and regenerative resistor on incombustible material. Installing them directly or close to combustibles will lead to a fire. Always connect a magnetic contactor (MC) between the main circuit power supply and L1, L2, and L3 of the servo amplifier, and configure the wiring to be able to shut down the power supply on the side of the servo amplifiers power supply. If a magnetic contactor (MC) is not connected, continuous flow of a large current may cause a fire when the servo amplifier malfunctions. When a regenerative resistor is used, use an alarm signal to switch main power off. Otherwise, a regenerative transistor fault or the like may overheat the regenerative resistor, causing a fire.
CAUTION
Only the voltage specified in the Instruction Manual should be applied to each terminal, Otherwise, a burst, damage, etc. may occur. Connect the terminals correctly to prevent a burst, damage, etc. Ensure that polarity ( , ) is correct. Otherwise, a burst, damage, etc. may occur.
Take safety measures, e.g. provide covers, to prevent accidental contact of hands and parts (cables, etc.) with the servo amplifier heat sink, regenerative resistor, servo motor, etc. since they may be hot while power is on or for some time after power-off. Their temperatures may be high and you may get burnt or a parts may damaged. During operation, never touch the rotating parts of the servo motor. Doing so can cause injury.
A- 2
4. Additional instructions
The following instructions should also be fully noted. Incorrect handling may cause a fault, injury, electric shock, etc.
CAUTION
Transport the products correctly according to their weights. Stacking in excess of the specified number of products is not allowed. Do not carry the servo motor by the cables, shaft or encoder. Do not hold the front cover to transport the servo amplifier. The servo amplifier may drop. Install the servo amplifier in a load-bearing place in accordance with the Instruction Manual. Do not climb or stand on servo equipment. Do not put heavy objects on equipment. The servo amplifier and servo motor must be installed in the specified direction. Leave specified clearances between the servo amplifier and control enclosure walls or other equipment. Do not install or operate the servo amplifier and servo motor which has been damaged or has any parts missing. Provide adequate protection to prevent screws and other conductive matter, oil and other combustible matter from entering the servo amplifier and servo motor. Do not drop or strike servo amplifier or servo motor. Isolate from all impact loads. When you keep or use it, please fulfill the following environmental conditions.
Environment In operation Ambient temperature In storage Ambient humidity Ambience Altitude (Note) Vibration In operation In storage [ [ [ [ ] ] ] ] Conditions Servo amplifier Servo motor 0 to 55 (non-freezing) 0 to 40 (non-freezing) 32 to 131 (non-freezing) 32 to 104 (non-freezing) 20 to 65 (non-freezing) 15 to 70 (non-freezing) 4 to 149 (non-freezing) 5 to 158 (non-freezing) 90 RH or less (non-condensing) 80 RH or less (non-condensing) 90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt Max. 1000m above sea level X Y : 49 HF-KE W1-S100 HF-SE52JW1-S100 to X Y : 24.5 5.9 or less HF-SE152JW1-S100 X : 24.5 HF-SE202JW1-S100 Y : 49
[m/s2]
Securely attach the servo motor to the machine. If attach insecurely, the servo motor may come off during operation. The servo motor with reduction gear must be installed in the specified direction to prevent oil leakage. Take safety measures, e.g. provide covers, to prevent accidental access to the rotating parts of the servo motor during operation. Never hit the servo motor or shaft, especially when coupling the servo motor to the machine. The encoder may become faulty. Do not subject the servo motor shaft to more than the permissible load. Otherwise, the shaft may break.
A- 3
(2) Wiring
CAUTION
Wire the equipment correctly and securely. Otherwise, the servo motor may operate unexpectedly. Do not install a power capacitor, surge absorber or radio noise filter (FR-BIF option) between the servo motor and servo amplifier. Connect the wires to the correct phase terminals (U, V, W) of the servo amplifier and servo motor. Otherwise, the servo motor does not operate properly. Connect the servo motor power terminal (U, V, W) to the servo motor power input terminal (U, V, W) directly. Do not let a magnetic contactor, etc. intervene.
Servo amplifier U V W U V W M Servo motor Servo amplifier U V W U V W M Servo motor
Do not connect AC power directly to the servo motor. Otherwise, a fault may occur. The surge absorbing diode installed on the DC output signal relay of the servo amplifier must be wired in the specified direction. Otherwise, the emergency stop and other protective circuits may not operate.
Servo amplifier SG Servo amplifier SG
RA
RA
When the cable is not tightened enough to the terminal block (connector), the cable or terminal block (connector) may generate heat because of the poor contact. Be sure to tighten the cable with specified torque.
CAUTION
Before operation, check the parameter settings. Improper settings may cause some machines to perform unexpected operation. The parameter settings must not be changed excessively. Operation will be insatiable.
A- 4
(4) Usage
CAUTION
Provide an external emergency stop circuit to ensure that operation can be stopped and power switched off immediately. Any person who is involved in disassembly and repair should be fully competent to do the work. Before resetting an alarm, make sure that the run signal of the servo amplifier is off to prevent an accident. A sudden restart is made if an alarm is reset with the run signal on. Do not modify the equipment. Use a noise filter, etc. to minimize the influence of electromagnetic interference, which may be caused by electronic equipment used near the servo amplifier. Burning or breaking a servo amplifier may cause a toxic gas. Do not burn or break a servo amplifier. Use the servo amplifier with the specified servo motor. The electromagnetic brake on the servo motor is designed to hold the servo motor shaft and should not be used for ordinary braking. For such reasons as service life and mechanical structure (e.g. where a ball screw and the servo motor are coupled via a timing belt), the electromagnetic brake may not hold the servo motor shaft. To ensure safety, install a stopper on the machine side.
CAUTION
When it is assumed that a hazardous condition may take place at the occur due to a power failure or a product fault, use a servo motor with electromagnetic brake or an external brake mechanism for the purpose of prevention. Configure the electromagnetic brake circuit so that it is activated not only by the servo amplifier signals but also by an external emergency stop (EMG).
Contacts must be open when servo-off, when an trouble (ALM) and when an electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR). SON RA Circuit must be opened during emergency stop (EMG).
EMG 24VDC
Electromagnetic brake
When any alarm has occurred, eliminate its cause, ensure safety, and deactivate the alarm before restarting operation. When power is restored after an instantaneous power failure, keep away from the machine because the machine may be restarted suddenly (design the machine so that it is secured against hazard if restarted).
A- 5
CAUTION
Note the following points when storing the servo motor for an extended period of time (guideline: three or more months). Always store the servo motor indoors in a clean and dry place. If it is stored in a dusty or damp place, make adequate provision, e.g. cover the whole product. If the insulation resistance of the winding decreases, reexamine the storage method. Though the servo motor is rust-proofed before shipment using paint or rust prevention oil, rust may be produced depending on the storage conditions or storage period. If the servo motor is to be stored for longer than six months, apply rust prevention oil again especially to the machined surfaces of the shaft, etc. Before using the product after storage for an extended period of time, hand-turn the motor output shaft to confirm that nothing is wrong with the servo motor. (When the servo motor is equipped with a brake, make the above check after releasing the brake with the brake power supply.) When the equipment has been stored for an extended period of time, consult Mitsubishi.
CAUTION
With age, the electrolytic capacitor of the servo amplifier will deteriorate. To prevent a secondary accident due to a fault, it is recommended to replace the electrolytic capacitor every 10 years when used in general environment. Please consult our sales representative.
A- 6
EEP-ROM life
The number of write times to the EEP-ROM, which stores parameter settings, etc., is limited to 100,000. If the total number of the following operations exceeds 100,000, the servo amplifier and/or converter unit may fail when the EEP-ROM reaches the end of its useful life. Write to the EEP-ROM due to parameter setting changes
A- 7
Magnetic contactor MC
Servo motor M
Use the circuit breaker and magnetic contactor which conform to the EN or IEC Standard. Design notice: Where residual-current-operated protective device (RCD) is used for protection case of direct or indirect contact, only RCD of type B is allowed on the supply side of this Electronic Equipment (EE). (3) Environment Operate the servo amplifier at or above the contamination level 2 set forth in IEC60664-1. For this purpose, install the servo amplifier in a control box which is protected against water, oil, carbon, dust, dirt, etc. (IP54). (4) Power supply (a) Operate the servo amplifier to meet the requirements of the overvoltage category II set forth in IEC60664-1. For this purpose, a reinforced insulating transformer conforming to the IEC or EN Standard should be used in the power input section. (b) As the external power supply for interface, use a 24VDC power supply that has been insulationreinforced in I/O. A- 8
(5) Grounding (a) To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminals (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. Connect PE terminal of the control box to the NEUTRAL of a power supply. Be sure to ground the NEUTRAL of a power supply. (b) Do not connect two ground cables to the same protective earth (PE) terminal. Always connect the cables to the terminals one-to-one.
PE terminals
PE terminals
(c) If a leakage current breaker is used to prevent an electric shock, the protective earth (PE) terminals of the servo amplifier must be connected to the corresponding earth terminals. (6) Wiring (a) The cables to be connected to the terminal block of the servo amplifier must have crimping terminals provided with insulating tubes to prevent contact with adjacent terminals.
Crimping terminal Insulating tube Cable
(b) Use the servo motor side power connector which complies with the EN Standard. The EN Standardcompliant power connector sets are available from us as options. (Refer to section 13.1.2) (7) Auxiliary equipment and options (a) The circuit breaker and magnetic contactor used should be the EN or IEC standard-compliant products of the models described in section 13.2.2. (b) The sizes of the cables described in section 13.2.1 meet the following requirements. To meet the other requirements, follow Table 5 and Appendix C in EN60204-1. Ambient temperature: 40 (104) [ ( )] Sheath: PVC (polyvinyl chloride) Installed on wall surface or open table tray (c) Use the EMC filter for noise reduction. (8) Performing EMC tests When EMC tests are run on a machine/device into which the servo amplifier has been installed, it must conform to the electromagnetic compatibility (immunity/emission) standards after it has satisfied the operating environment/electrical equipment specifications. For the other EMC directive guidelines on the servo amplifier, refer to the EMC Installation Guidelines (IB(NA)67310). A- 9
2 3
(5) Options and auxiliary equipment Use UL/C-UL standard-compliant products. (6) About wiring protection For installation in United States, branch circuit protection must be provided, in accordance with the National Electrical Code and any applicable local codes. For installation in Canada, branch circuit protection must be provided, in accordance with the Canada Electrical Code and any applicable provincial codes. <<About the manuals>> Relevant manuals
Manual name MR-E Series Instructions and Cautions for Safe Use of AC Servos EMC Installation Guidelines Manual No. IB(NA)0300057 IB(NA)67310
A - 10
CONTENTS
1- 1 to 1-10
1.1 Introduction................................................................................................................................................ 1- 1 1.2 Function block diagram............................................................................................................................. 1- 2 1.3 Servo amplifier standard specifications.................................................................................................... 1- 3 1.4 Function list ............................................................................................................................................... 1- 4 1.5 Model code definition ................................................................................................................................ 1- 6 1.6 Combination with servo motor .................................................................................................................. 1- 6 1.7 Parts identification..................................................................................................................................... 1- 7 1.8 Servo system with auxiliary equipment .................................................................................................... 1- 9 2. INSTALLATION 2- 1 to 2- 4
2.1 Environmental conditions.......................................................................................................................... 2- 1 2.2 Installation direction and clearances ........................................................................................................ 2- 2 2.3 Keep out foreign materials........................................................................................................................ 2- 3 2.4 Cable stress .............................................................................................................................................. 2- 3 3. SIGNALS AND WIRING 3- 1 to 3- 48
3.1 Standard connection example .................................................................................................................. 3- 2 3.1.1 Position control mode......................................................................................................................... 3- 2 3.1.2 Internal speed control mode .............................................................................................................. 3- 8 3.2 Internal connection diagram of servo amplifier ........................................................................................ 3- 9 3.3 I/O signals................................................................................................................................................. 3-10 3.3.1 Connectors and signal arrangements .............................................................................................. 3-10 3.3.2 Signal explanations ........................................................................................................................... 3-13 3.4 Detailed description of the signals........................................................................................................... 3-19 3.4.1 Position control mode........................................................................................................................ 3-19 3.4.2 Internal speed control mode ............................................................................................................. 3-24 3.4.3 Position/internal speed control change mode .................................................................................. 3-26 3.5 Alarm occurrence timing chart................................................................................................................. 3-28 3.6 Interfaces.................................................................................................................................................. 3-29 3.6.1 Common line ..................................................................................................................................... 3-29 3.6.2 Detailed description of the interfaces ............................................................................................... 3-30 3.7 Input power supply circuit ........................................................................................................................ 3-34 3.7.1 Connection example ......................................................................................................................... 3-34 3.7.2 Terminals ........................................................................................................................................... 3-35 3.7.3 Power-on sequence .......................................................................................................................... 3-36 3.8 Connection of servo amplifier and servo motor ...................................................................................... 3-37 3.8.1 Connection instructions..................................................................................................................... 3-37 3.8.2 Power supply cable wiring diagrams ................................................................................................ 3-38 3.9 Servo motor with electromagnetic brake................................................................................................. 3-41 3.9.1 Precautions........................................................................................................................................ 3-41 3.9.2 Setting................................................................................................................................................ 3-41 3.9.3 Timing charts ..................................................................................................................................... 3-42 3.10 Grounding............................................................................................................................................... 3-44 1
3.11 Servo amplifier connectors (CNP1, CNP2) wiring method (When MR-ECPN1-B and MR-ECPN2-B of an option are used.) ....................................................... 3-45 3.12 Instructions for the 3M connector .......................................................................................................... 3-48 4. OPERATION 4- 1 to 4- 6
4.1 When switching power on for the first time .............................................................................................. 4- 1 4.2 Startup ....................................................................................................................................................... 4- 2 4.2.1 Selection of control mode .................................................................................................................. 4- 2 4.2.2 Position control mode......................................................................................................................... 4- 2 4.2.3 Internal speed control mode .............................................................................................................. 4- 4 5. PARAMETERS 5- 1 to 5- 30
5.1 Parameter list ............................................................................................................................................ 5- 1 5.1.1 Parameter write inhibit ....................................................................................................................... 5- 1 5.1.2 Lists..................................................................................................................................................... 5- 2 5.2 Detailed description.................................................................................................................................. 5-24 5.2.1 Electronic gear................................................................................................................................... 5-24 5.2.2 Analog monitor .................................................................................................................................. 5-25 5.2.3 Using forward/reverse rotation stroke end to change the stopping pattern .................................... 5-28 5.2.4 Alarm history clear............................................................................................................................. 5-28 5.2.5 Position smoothing............................................................................................................................ 5-29 6. DISPLAY AND OPERATION 6- 1 to 6-14
6.1 Display flowchart ....................................................................................................................................... 6- 1 6.2 Status display ............................................................................................................................................ 6- 2 6.2.1 Display examples ............................................................................................................................... 6- 2 6.2.2 Status display list................................................................................................................................ 6- 3 6.2.3 Changing the status display screen................................................................................................... 6- 4 6.3 Diagnostic mode ....................................................................................................................................... 6- 5 6.4 Alarm mode ............................................................................................................................................... 6- 6 6.5 Parameter mode ....................................................................................................................................... 6- 7 6.6 External I/O signal display ........................................................................................................................ 6- 8 6.7 Output signal (DO) forced output............................................................................................................. 6-10 6.8 Test operation mode ................................................................................................................................ 6-11 6.8.1 Mode change..................................................................................................................................... 6-11 6.8.2 Jog operation..................................................................................................................................... 6-12 6.8.3 Positioning operation......................................................................................................................... 6-13 6.8.4 Motor-less operation ......................................................................................................................... 6-14 7. GENERAL GAIN ADJUSTMENT 7- 1 to 7-10
7.1 Different adjustment methods................................................................................................................... 7- 1 7.1.1 Adjustment on a single servo amplifier.............................................................................................. 7- 1 7.1.2 Adjustment using MR Configurator (servo configuration software).................................................. 7- 2 7.2 Auto tuning ................................................................................................................................................ 7- 3 7.2.1 Auto tuning mode ............................................................................................................................... 7- 3 7.2.2 Auto tuning mode operation............................................................................................................... 7- 4 2
7.2.3 Adjustment procedure by auto tuning................................................................................................ 7- 5 7.2.4 Response level setting in auto tuning mode ..................................................................................... 7- 6 7.3 Manual mode 1 (simple manual adjustment) ........................................................................................... 7- 7 7.3.1 Operation of manual mode 1 ............................................................................................................. 7- 7 7.3.2 Adjustment by manual mode 1 .......................................................................................................... 7- 7 7.4 Interpolation mode ................................................................................................................................... 7-10 8. SPECIAL ADJUSTMENT FUNCTIONS 8- 1 to 8-10
8.1 Function block diagram............................................................................................................................. 8- 1 8.2 Machine resonance suppression filter...................................................................................................... 8- 1 8.3 Adaptive vibration suppression control .................................................................................................... 8- 3 8.4 Low-pass filter ........................................................................................................................................... 8- 4 8.5 Gain changing function ............................................................................................................................. 8- 5 8.5.1 Applications ........................................................................................................................................ 8- 5 8.5.2 Function block diagram...................................................................................................................... 8- 5 8.5.3 Parameters ......................................................................................................................................... 8- 6 8.5.4 Gain changing operation.................................................................................................................... 8- 8 9. INSPECTION 10. TROUBLESHOOTING 9- 1 to 9- 2 10- 1 to 10-12
10.1 Trouble at start-up................................................................................................................................. 10- 1 10.1.1 Position control mode..................................................................................................................... 10- 1 10.1.2 Internal speed control mode .......................................................................................................... 10- 4 10.2 When alarm or warning has occurred .................................................................................................. 10- 5 10.2.1 Alarms and warning list.................................................................................................................. 10- 5 10.2.2 Remedies for alarms...................................................................................................................... 10- 6 10.2.3 Remedies for warnings ................................................................................................................. 10-11 11. OUTLINE DIMENSION DRAWINGS 11- 1 to 11- 8
11.1 Servo amplifiers .................................................................................................................................... 11- 1 11.2 Connectors ............................................................................................................................................ 11- 5 12. CHARACTERISTICS 12- 1 to 12- 4
12.1 Overload protection characteristics ...................................................................................................... 12- 1 12.2 Power supply equipment capacity and generated loss ....................................................................... 12- 1 12.3 Dynamic brake characteristics.............................................................................................................. 12- 3 12.4 Encoder cable flexing life...................................................................................................................... 12- 4 12.5 Inrush currents at power-on of main circuit and control circuit ............................................................ 12- 4 13. OPTIONS AND AUXILIARY EQUIPMENT 13- 1 to 13-42
13.1 Options .................................................................................................................................................. 13- 1 13.1.1 Regenerative options ..................................................................................................................... 13- 1 13.1.2 Cables and connectors .................................................................................................................. 13- 6 13.1.3 Analog monitor, RS-232C branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P) ........................................................ 13-27 3
13.1.4 MR Configurator (servo configurations software) ........................................................................ 13-28 13.2 Auxiliary equipment.............................................................................................................................. 13-29 13.2.1 Selection example of wires ........................................................................................................... 13-29 13.2.2 Circuit breakers, fuses, magnetic contactors ............................................................................... 13-31 13.2.3 Power factor improving reactors................................................................................................... 13-31 13.2.4 Relays............................................................................................................................................ 13-32 13.2.5 Surge absorbers............................................................................................................................ 13-32 13.2.6 Noise reduction techniques .......................................................................................................... 13-33 13.2.7 Leakage current breaker............................................................................................................... 13-40 13.2.8 EMC filter ....................................................................................................................................... 13-42 14. SERVO MOTOR 14- 1 to 14- 42
14.1 Compliance with the overseas standards ............................................................................................ 14- 1 14.1.1 Compliance with EC directives ...................................................................................................... 14- 1 14.1.2 Conformance with UL/C-UL standard ........................................................................................... 14- 1 14.2 Introduction............................................................................................................................................ 14- 2 14.2.1 Features of servo motor................................................................................................................. 14- 2 14.2.2 Rating plate .................................................................................................................................... 14- 2 14.2.3 Parts identification .......................................................................................................................... 14- 3 14.2.4 Electromagnetic brake characteristics........................................................................................... 14- 4 14.2.5 Servo motor shaft shapes .............................................................................................................. 14- 5 14.3 Installation ............................................................................................................................................. 14- 6 14.3.1 Installation orientation .................................................................................................................... 14- 7 14.3.2 Load remove precautions .............................................................................................................. 14- 7 14.3.3 Permissible load for the shaft ........................................................................................................ 14- 8 14.3.4 Protection from oil and water ......................................................................................................... 14- 8 14.3.5 Cable .............................................................................................................................................. 14- 9 14.3.6 Inspection ...................................................................................................................................... 14-10 14.3.7 Life ................................................................................................................................................. 14-10 14.3.8 Machine accuracies ...................................................................................................................... 14-11 14.4 Connectors used for servo motor wiring ............................................................................................. 14-12 14.4.1 Selection of connectors................................................................................................................. 14-12 14.4.2 Wiring connectors (Connector configurations A B C) .............................................................. 14-12 14.4.3 Wiring connectors (Connector configurations D, E, F, G, H)....................................................... 14-14 14.5 Connector outline drawings ................................................................................................................. 14-17 14.6 HF-KE W1-S100................................................................................................................................ 14-22 14.6.1 Model name make up ................................................................................................................... 14-22 14.6.2 Standard specifications................................................................................................................. 14-23 14.6.3 Electromagnetic brake characteristics.......................................................................................... 14-25 14.6.4 Servo motors with special shafts .................................................................................................. 14-26 14.6.5 Outline dimension drawings.......................................................................................................... 14-27 14.7 HF-SE JW1-S100.............................................................................................................................. 14-34 14.7.1 Model name make up ................................................................................................................... 14-34 14.7.2 Standard specifications................................................................................................................. 14-35 14.7.3 Electromagnetic brake characteristics.......................................................................................... 14-37 14.7.4 Servo motors with special shafts .................................................................................................. 14-38 14.7.5 Outline dimension drawings.......................................................................................................... 14-39
15. MR-E-
15- 1 to 15- 64
15.1. Functions and configuration................................................................................................................. 15- 1 15.1.1 Introduction..................................................................................................................................... 15- 1 15.1.2 Function block diagram.................................................................................................................. 15- 2 15.1.3 Servo amplifier standard specifications......................................................................................... 15- 3 15.1.4 Model code definition ..................................................................................................................... 15- 4 15.1.5 Parts identification .......................................................................................................................... 15- 4 15.1.6 Servo system with auxiliary equipment ......................................................................................... 15- 6 15.2. Signals and wiring ................................................................................................................................ 15- 8 15.2.1 Standard connection example ....................................................................................................... 15- 8 15.2.2 Internal connection diagram of servo amplifier ............................................................................ 15-11 15.2.3 Connectors and signal arrangements .......................................................................................... 15-12 15.2.4 Signal explanations ....................................................................................................................... 15-14 15.2.5 Detailed description of the signals................................................................................................ 15-20 15.3 Startup .................................................................................................................................................. 15-27 15.3.1 Speed control mode ...................................................................................................................... 15-27 15.3.2 Torque control mode ..................................................................................................................... 15-30 15.4 Parameters........................................................................................................................................... 15-32 15.4.1 Item list .......................................................................................................................................... 15-32 15.4.2 Details list ...................................................................................................................................... 15-35 15.5 Display and operation .......................................................................................................................... 15-55 15.5.1 Display flowchart ........................................................................................................................... 15-55 15.5.2 Status display ................................................................................................................................ 15-56 15.5.3 Diagnostic mode............................................................................................................................ 15-58 15.5.4 External I/O signal display ............................................................................................................ 15-60 15.6. Troubleshooting .................................................................................................................................. 15-62 15.6.1 Trouble at start-up ......................................................................................................................... 15-62 15.6.2 Alarms and warning list................................................................................................................. 15-64 APPENDIX App.- 1
MEMO
1- 1
D (Note 1)
Diode stack
Relay
CHARGE lamp
Dynamic brake RA
24VDC B1
Electromagnetic brake
Encoder
Pulse input
Virtual encoder
Model position control Model speed control
Virtual motor
Model position
Actual position control
Model speed
Actual speed control
D/A
Note 1. The built-in regenerative resistor is not provided for the MR-E-10A-QW003/MR-E-20A-QW003. 2. The single-phase 230VAC can be used for MR-E-70A-QW003 or smaller servo amplifier. Connect the power supply cables to L1 and L2 while leaving L3 open. Refer to section 1.3 for the power supply specification. 3. The control circuit connectors (CN1, CN2 and CN3) are safely isolated from main circuit terminals (L1, L2, L3, U, V, W, P, C and D). 4. Servo amplifiers MR-E-200A-QW003 have a cooling fan.
1- 2
Inrush current Control system Dynamic brake Protective functions Max. input pulse frequency Command pulse multiplying factor In-position range setting Error excessive Torque limit Speed control range Speed fluctuation ratio Torque limit
Structure
90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt Max. 1000m above sea level 5.9 [m/s2] or less [kg] 0.7 0.7 1.1 1.7 1.7 2.0
1- 3
1.4 Function list The following table lists the functions of this servo. For details of the functions, refer to the reference field.
Function Description (Note) Control mode P Reference Section 3.1.1 Section 3.4.1 Section 4.2.2 Section 3.1.2 Section 3.4.2 Section 4.2.3 Section 3.4.4
Internal speed control mode Position/internal speed control change mode High-resolution encoder
This servo is used as internal speed control servo. Using external input signal, control can be switched between position control and internal speed control. High-resolution encoder of 131072 pulses/rev is used as a servo motor encoder. You can switch between gains during rotation and gains during stop or use an external input signal to change gains during operation.
P/S P, S
P, S
Section 8.5
Adaptive vibration suppression Servo amplifier detects mechanical resonance and sets filter control characteristics automatically to suppress mechanical vibration. Low-pass filter Suppresses high-frequency resonance which occurs as servo system response is increased. Analyzes the frequency characteristic of the mechanical system by simply connecting a MR Configurator (servo configuration software)-installed personal computer and servo amplifier. Can simulate machine motions on a personal computer screen on the basis of the machine analyzer results. Personal computer changes gains automatically and searches for overshoot-free gains in a short time. Suppresses vibration of stop. 1 pulse produced at a servo motor
P, S P, S
Machine simulation Gain search function Slight vibration suppression control Electronic gear Auto tuning Position smoothing S-pattern acceleration/ deceleration time constant Regenerative option
Input pulses can be multiplied by 1/50 to 50. Automatically adjusts the gain to optimum value if load applied to the servo motor shaft varies. Speed can be increased smoothly in response to input pulse. Speed can be increased and decreased smoothly. Used when the built-in regenerative resistor of the servo amplifier does not have sufficient regenerative capability for the regenerative power generated.
P, S
Section 13.1.1
1- 4
Function Alarm history clear Restart after instantaneous power failure Command pulse selection Input signal selection Torque limit Status display External I/O signal display Output signal (DO) forced output Test operation mode Analog monitor output MR Configurator (servo configuration software) Alarm code output Alarm history is cleared.
Description
If the input power supply voltage had reduced to cause an alarm but has returned to normal, the servo motor can be restarted by merely switching on the start signal. Command pulse train form can be selected from among four different types. Forward rotation start, reverse rotation start, servo-on and other input signals can be assigned to any pins. Servo motor torque can be limited to any value. Servo status is shown on the 5-digit, 7-segment LED display ON/OFF statuses of external I/O signals are shown on the display. Output signal can be forced on/off independently of the servo status. Use this function for output signal wiring check, etc. Servo motor can be run from the operation section of the servo amplifier without the start signal entered. Servo status is output in terms of voltage in real time. Using a personal computer, parameter setting, test operation, status display, etc. can be performed. If an alarm has occurred, the corresponding alarm number is output in 3-bit code.
P P, S P, S P, S P, S
Parameter No.21 Parameters No.43 to 48 Section 3.4.1 (5) Parameter No.28 Section 6.2 Section 6.6
P, S
Section 6.7
P, S P, S P, S P, S
Note. P: Position control mode, S: Internal speed control mode P/S: Position/internal speed control change mode
1- 5
2.8A
:TCXXXAYYYGZZ
(2) Model
MR-E Super servo amplifier (Source I/O interface) Series Rated output Pulse train interface MR-E-200A-QW003
MR-E-40A-QW003 or less MR-E-70A-QW003, MR-E-100A-QW003 Symbol Rated output [W] Symbol Rated output [W] 100 10 750 70 20 200 100 1000 40 400 200 2000
Rating plate
1.6 Combination with servo motor The following table lists combinations of servo amplifiers and servo motors. The same combinations apply to the servo motor models with electromagnetic brakes.
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 Servo motors HF-KE W1-S100 13 23 43 73 52 102 152 202 HF-SE JW1-S100
1- 6
MODE
UP
DOWN
MODE CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-
SET
Used to change the display or data in each mode. Used to change the mode. Communication connector (CN3) Used to connect a command device (RS-232C) and output analog monitor data. Section 3.3 Section 13.1.2
CN1
CN2
WV U
CHARGE
CNP2
I/O signal connector (CN1) Used to connect digital I/O signals. Encoder connector (CN2) Use to connect the servo motor encoder. Charge lamp Lit to indicate that the main circuit is charged. While this lamp is lit, do not reconnect the cables. Servo motor power connector (CNP2) Used to connect the servo motor. Power supply/regenerative connector (CNP1) Used to connect the input power supply and regenerative option.
CNP1
L3L2L1 D C P
Section 3.7 Section 11.1 Section 3.7 Section 11.1 Section 13.1.1 Section 3.10 Section 11.1
Protective earth (PE) terminal ( Fixed part Ground terminal. (MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-40A-QW003: 2 places MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003: 3 places)
1- 7
(2) MR-E-200A-QW003
Name/application Display The 5-digit, seven-segment LED shows the servo status and alarm number. Operation section Used to perform status display, diagnostic, alarm and parameter setting operations. Reference Chapter 6
MODE
UP
DOWN
SET Used to set data. Used to change the display or data in each mode. Used to change the mode. Chapter 6
Communication connector (CN3) Used to connect a command device (RS-232C) and output analog monitor data. I/O signal connector (CN1) Used to connect digital I/O signals. Rating plate Encoder connector (CN2) Used to connect the servo motor encoder. Power supply/regenerative connector (CNP1) Used to connect the input power supply and regenerative option. Charge lamp Lit to indicate that the main circuit is charged. While this lamp is lit, do not reconnect the cables. Protective earth (PE) terminal ( Ground terminal. )
Section 3.3 Section 1.5 Section 3.3 Section 13.1.2 Section 3.7 Section 11.1 Section 13.1.1
Servo motor power connector (CNP2) Used to connect the servo motor.
1- 8
1.8 Servo system with auxiliary equipment To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box.
WARNING
MODE CN3
SET
To CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-E-
To CN1
CN1
Command device
W V U
To CN2
CN2 CNP2
CNP1
Protective earth
Note. A 1-phase 230VAC power supply may be used with the servo amplifier of MR-E-70A-QW003 or less. Connect the power supply to L1 and L2 terminals and leave L3 open. Refer to section 1.3 for the power supply specification.
L3 L2 L1 D C P
CHARGE
To CNP2
1- 9
(2) MR-E-200A-QW003
(Note) Power supply Options and auxiliary equipment Circuit breaker Magnetic contactor MR Configurator (Servo configuration software) Circuit breaker (NFB) or fuse Reference Section 13.2.2 Section 13.2.2 Section 13.1.4 Options and auxiliary equipment Regenerative option Cables Power factor improving reactor Reference Section 13.1.1 Section 13.2.1 Section 13.2.3
Servo amplifier
Personal computer
MODE
MITSUBISHI EZMotion
SET
To CN3
CN3
D C P L3 L2 L1
To CN1
CN1 CNP1
Command device
To CN2
CN2
CHARGE
L1
L2
W V U
To CNP2
CNP2
L3
P C Regenerative option
Servo motor
1 - 10
2. INSTALLATION
2. INSTALLATION
Stacking in excess of the limited number of products is not allowed. Install the equipment to incombustibles. Installing them directly or close to combustibles will led to a fire. Install the equipment on incombustible material. Installing them directly or close to combustibles will lead to a fire. Do not get on or put heavy load on the equipment to prevent injury. Use the equipment within the specified environmental condition range. (For details of the environmental condition, refer to section 2.1.) Provide an adequate protection to prevent screws, metallic detritus and other conductive matter or oil and other combustible matter from entering the servo amplifier. Do not block the intake/exhaust ports of the servo amplifier. Otherwise, a fault may occur. Do not subject the servo amplifier to drop impact or shock loads as they are precision equipment. Do not install or operate a faulty servo amplifier. When the product has been stored for an extended period of time, consult Mitsubishi. When treating the servo amplifier, be careful about the edged parts such as the corners of the servo amplifier.
CAUTION
90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt Max. 1000m above sea level 5.9 [m/s2] or less
2- 1
2. INSTALLATION
2.2 Installation direction and clearances The equipment must be installed in the specified direction. Otherwise, a fault may occur. Leave specified clearances between the servo amplifier and control box inside walls or other equipment.
Control box
CAUTION
Top
10mm or more
CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-
CN1
CN2 CNP2
WV U
CNP1
L3L2L1 D C P
CHARGE
(2) Installation of two or more servo amplifiers Leave a large clearance between the top of the servo amplifier and the internal surface of the control box, and install a cooling fan to prevent the internal temperature of the control box from exceeding the environmental conditions.
Control box
100mm or more
30mm or more
MODE CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-
SET
SET
30mm or more
CN1
CN1
CN2
WV U
L3 L2L1 D C P
CNP1
CNP1
L3 L2L1 D C P
CHARGE
CNP2
2- 2
2. INSTALLATION
(3) Others When using heat generating equipment such as the regenerative option, install them with full consideration of heat generation so that the servo amplifier is not affected. Install the servo amplifier on a perpendicular wall in the correct vertical direction. 2.3 Keep out foreign materials (1) When installing the unit in a control box, prevent drill chips and wire fragments from entering the servo amplifier. (2) Prevent oil, water, metallic dust, etc. from entering the servo amplifier through openings in the control box or a cooling fan installed on the ceiling. (3) When installing the control box in a place where there are much toxic gas, dirt and dust, conduct an air purge (force clean air into the control box from outside to make the internal pressure higher than the external pressure) to prevent such materials from entering the control box. 2.4 Cable stress (1) The way of clamping the cable must be fully examined so that flexing stress and cable's own weight stress are not applied to the cable connection. (2) For use in any application where the servo motor moves, fix the cables (encoder, power supply, brake) supplied with the servo motor, and flex the optional encoder cable or the power supply and brake wiring cables. Use the optional encoder cable within the flexing life range. Use the power supply and brake wiring cables within the flexing life of the cables. (3) Avoid any probability that the cable sheath might be cut by sharp chips, rubbed by a machine corner or stamped by workers or vehicles. (4) For installation on a machine where the servo motor will move, the flexing radius should be made as large as possible. Refer to section 12.4 for the flexing life.
2- 3
2. INSTALLATION
MEMO
2- 4
WARNING
Ground the servo amplifier and the servo motor securely. Do not attempt to wire the servo amplifier and servo motor until they have been installed. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock. The cables should not be damaged, stressed excessively, loaded heavily, or pinched. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock. Wire the equipment correctly and securely. Otherwise, the servo motor may operate unexpectedly, resulting in injury. Connect cables to correct terminals to prevent a burst, fault, etc. Ensure that polarity ( , ) is correct. Otherwise, a burst, damage, etc. may occur. The surge absorbing diode installed to the DC relay designed for control output should be fitted in the specified direction. Otherwise, the signal is not output due to a fault, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits.
Servo amplifier SG Servo amplifier SG
CAUTION
RA
RA
Use a noise filter, etc. to minimize the influence of electromagnetic interference, which may be given to electronic equipment used near the servo amplifier. Do not install a power capacitor, surge suppressor or radio noise filter (FR-BIF option) with the power line of the servo motor. When using the regenerative resistor, switch power off with the alarm signal. Otherwise, a transistor fault or the like may overheat the regenerative resistor, causing a fire. Do not modify the equipment. During power-on, do not open or close the motor power line. Otherwise, a malfunction or faulty may occur.
3- 1
3.1 Standard connection example POINT Refer to section 3.7.1 for the connection of the power supply system and to section 3.8 for connection with the servo motor. 3.1.1 Position control mode (1) FX-10GM
Positioning module FX-10GM Servo amplifier
(Note 7) CN1 (Note 7) CN1
(Note 10)
1 2 12 11 14 13
11 13 10 1 21 2 1 23 13 25 1 5 Plate
1 9 12 13
7,17 24 8,18 VC 5 FPO 6 FP COM5 9,19 16 RP 15 RPO 3 CLR 4 COM3 (Note 8) 2m max. START 1 STOP 2 ZRN 3 FWD 4 RVS 5 DOG 6 LSF 7 LSR 8 COM1 9,19 10m max. (Note 3, 4) Emergency stop Servo-on Reset (Note 4) Forward rotation stroke end Reverse rotation stroke end
(Note 7) CN1 15 16 17 18 14 19 20 Plate LA LAR LB LBR LG LZ LZR SD Encoder A-phase pulse (differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (differential line driver) Control common Encoder Z-phase pulse (differential line driver)
A A
10k 10k
2m max.
(Note 7) CN3
(Note 1)
3- 2
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) and forward rotation stroke end (LSN), reverse rotation stroke end (LSP) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. When this signal is switched off (at occurrence of an alarm), the output of the controller should be stopped by the sequence program. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. This length applies to the command pulse train input in the open collector system. It is 10m or less in the differential line driver system. 9. Use MRZJW3-SETUP154E of 154C. 10. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
3- 3
(2) AD75P
(A1SD75P )
Positioning module AD75P (A1SD75P ) Servo amplifier (Note 7) CN1 11 RD 13 SG 10 INP 19 LZ 20 LZR 1 VIN 5 CR 22 PG 23 PP 24 NG 25 NP 14 LG SD Plate (Note 7) CN1 1 9 12 13 VIN ALM ZSP SG
(Note 2)
(Note 11)
RA1 RA2
1 19 2 20 11 12 13 14 15 16 35 36
(Note 10)
(Note 7) CN1
15 24VDC 16 17 18 14 21 Plate
(Note 7) (Note 7) CN3 CN1
LA LAR LB LBR LG OP SD
Encoder A-phase pulse (differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (differential line driver) Control common Encoder Z-phase pulse (open collector)
(Note 3, 4) Emergency stop Servo-on Reset (Note 4) Forward rotation stroke end Reverse rotation stroke end
8 4 3 6 7 1
4 3 6 Plate
MO1 LG MO2 SD
A A
10k 10k
2m max.
3- 4
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) and forward rotation stroke end (LSN), reverse rotation stroke end (LSP) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. When this signal is switched off (at occurrence of an alarm), the output of the controller should be stopped by the sequence program. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. This length applies to the command pulse train input in the differential line driver system. It is 2m or less in the open collector system. 9. Use MRZJW3-SETUP154E of 154C. 10. To enhance noise immunity, connect LG and pulse output COM. 11. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
3- 5
(3) QD75D
(differential driver)
(Note 8) 10m max. 11 12 9 10 13 14 16 15 18 17 Servo amplifier
(Note 7) CN1 (Note 7) CN1
(Note 11)
(Note 10)
1 9 12 10 13
(Note 2)
5V
(Note 7) CN1
15 16 17 18 14 21 Plate
LA LAR LB LBR LG OP SD
Encoder A-phase pulse (differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (differential line driver) Control common Encoder Z-phase pulse (open collector)
(Note 3, 4) Emergency stop Servo-on Reset (Note 4) Forward rotation stroke end Reverse rotation stroke end 10m or less (Note 9) MR Configurator (Servo configuration software)
8 4 3 6 7 1
(Note 7) CN3
4 3 6 Plate
MO1 LG MO2 SD
A A
10k 10k
(Note 7) CN3
(Note 1)
3- 6
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) and forward rotation stroke end (LSN), reverse rotation stroke end (LSP) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. When this signal is switched off (at occurrence of an alarm), the output of the controller should be stopped by the sequence program. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. This length applies to the command pulse train input in the differential line driver system. It is 2m or less in the open collector system. 9. Use MRZJW3-SETUP154E of 154C. 10. This connection is not required for the QD75D. Depending on the used positioning module, however, it is recommended to connect the LG and control common terminals of the servo amplifier to enhance noise immunity. 11. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
3- 7
(Note 9)
RA4
(Note 7) CN3 4 (Note 8) MR Configurator (Servo configuration software) 3 6 Personal computer (Note 6) Communication cable (Note 7) CN3 Plate MO1 LG MO2 SD 2m max. A A 10k 10k (Note 6) Monitor output Max. 1mA Reading in both directions
(Note 1)
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) and forward rotation stroke end (LSN), reverse rotation stroke end (LSP) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. Use MRZJW3-SETUP154E of 154C. 9. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
3- 8
3.2 Internal connection diagram of servo amplifier The following is the internal connection diagram where the signal assignment has been made in the initial status in each control mode.
Servo amplifier (Note) P VIN External power supply 24VDC CR SON RES S VIN ST2 SON ST1 CN1 1 5 4 3 8 6 7 13 2 22 23 24 25 SD Case
Approx. 100 Approx. 100 Approx. 1.2k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k
CN1 15 16 17
Approx. 1.2k
18 19 20 21 14 CN3 4 6 2 1 3 Case PE
3- 9
3.3 I/O signals 3.3.1 Connectors and signal arrangements POINT The pin configurations of the connectors are as viewed from the cable connector wiring section. Refer to the next page for CN1 signal assignment. (1) Signal arrangement
5 CN3 3 LG 1 RXD 1 MODE CN3 6 MO2 4 MO1 2 TXD
MITSUBISHI MR-E
SET
2 OPC 4 SON
CN1
6 LSP
CN2
WV U
CNP2
CN2 2
LG
4
MRR
6 5
8
MDR
10
LG
CNP1
1
P5
3
MR
7
MD
9 The connector frames are connected with the PE (earth) terminal inside the servo amplifier.
3 - 10
L3L2L1 D C P
(2) CN1 signal assignment The signal assignment of connector changes with the control mode as indicated below; For the pins which are given parameter No.s in the related parameter column, their signals can be changed using those parameters.
Connector Pin No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 CN1 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 Note 1. I: Input signal, O: Output signal 2. P: Position control mode, S: Internal speed control mode, P/S: Position/internal speed control change mode O O O O O O O I I I I I I I I I I O O O O (Note 1) I/O (Note 2) I/O Signals in control modes P VIN OPC RES SON CR LSP LSN EMG ALM INP RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP PG PP NG NP P/S VIN OPC RES/ST1 SON LOP LSP LSN EMG ALM INP/SA RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP PG/ PP/ NG/ NP/ ST1 SON ST2 LSP LSN EMG ALM SA RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP No.49 No.49 No.49 No.1, 49 No.43 to 48 No.43 to 48 No.43 to 48 No.43 No.43 48 48 S VIN Related parameter
3 - 11
3 - 12
3.3.2 Signal explanations For the I/O interfaces (symbols in I/O column in the table), refer to section 3.6.2. In the control mode field of the table P : Position control mode, S: Internal speed control mode : Denotes that the signal may be used in the initial setting status. : Denotes that the signal may be used by setting the corresponding parameter among parameters No.43 to 49. The pin No.s in the connector pin No. column are those in the initial status. (1) Input signals POINT The acceptance delay time of each input signal is less than 10ms.
Control mode P S
Signal Servo-on
Symbol SON
Functions/applications Connect SON-VIN to switch on the base circuit and make the servo amplifier ready to operate (servo-on). Disconnect SON-VIN to shut off the base circuit and coast the servo motor (servo off) . Set " 1" in parameter No.41 to switch this signal on (keep terminals connected) automatically in the servo amplifier. Disconnect RES-VIN for more than 50ms to reset the alarm. Some alarms cannot be deactivated by the reset (RES). (Refer to section 10.2.1.) Shorting RES-VIN in an alarm-free status shuts off the base circuit. The base circuit is not shut off when " 1 " is set in parameter No.51. This device is not designed to make a stop. Do not turn it ON during operation. To start operation, short LSP-VIN and/or LSN-VIN. Open them to bring the motor to a sudden stop and make it servo-locked. Set " 1" in parameter No.22 to make a slow stop. (Refer to section 5.2.3.) (Note) Input signals LSP 1 0 LSN 1 1 0 0 Operation CCW direction CW direction
Reset
RES
CN1-3
DI-1
LSP
CN1-6
DI-1
LSN
CN1-7
1 0
Note. 0: LSP/LSN-VIN off (open) 1: LSP/LSN-VIN on (short) Set parameter No.41 as indicated below to switch on the signals (keep terminals connected) automatically in the servo amplifier. Parameter No.41 1 1 Automatic ON LSP LSN
3 - 13
Symbol TL1
Functions/applications When using this signal, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. (Refer to section 3.4.1 (5).)
Control mode P S
ST1
CN1-3
Used to start the servo motor in any of the following directions. (Note) Input signals ST2 0 ST1 0 1 0 1 Servo motor starting direction Stop (servo lock) CCW CW Stop (servo lock)
DI-1
ST2
CN1-5
0 1 1
Note. 0: ST1/ST2-VIN off (open) 1: ST1/ST2-VIN on (short) If both ST1 and ST2 are switched on or off during operation, the servo motor will be decelerated to a stop according to the parameter No.12 setting and servo-locked. Speed selection 1 SP1 <Internal speed control mode> Used to select the command speed for operation. When using SP1 to SP3, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. (Note) Input signals SP3 Speed selection 3 SP3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Servo motor starting direction Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed command 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed command 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed command 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed command 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed command 7 (parameter No.75) DI-1
Speed selection 2
SP2
DI-1 DI-1
Note. 0: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN off (open) 1: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN on (short) Proportion control PC Connect PC-VIN to switch the speed amplifier from the proportional integral type to the proportional type. If the servo motor at a stop is rotated even one pulse due to any external factor, it generates torque to compensate for a position shift. When the servo motor shaft is to be locked mechanically after positioning completion (stop), switching on the proportion control signal (PC) upon positioning completion will suppress the unnecessary torque generated to compensate for a position shift. When the shaft is to be locked for a long time, set the internal torque limit 1 and 2 (parameter No.28 and 76) to make the torque less than the rated torque at the same time of turning ON the proportion control signal. DI-1
3 - 14
Symbol EMG
Functions/applications Disconnect EMG-VIN to bring the servo motor to emergency stop state, in which the servo is switched off and the dynamic brake is operated. Connect EMG-VIN in the emergency stop state to reset that state. Connect CR-VIN to clear the position control counter droop pulses on its leading edge. The pulse width should be 10ms or more. When the parameter No.42 setting is " 1 ", the pulses are always cleared while CR-VIN are connected. When using CM1 and CM2, make them usable by the setting of parameters No.43 to 48. The combination of CM1-VIN and CM2-VIN gives you a choice of four different electronic gear numerators set in the parameters. CM1 and CM2 cannot be used in the absolute position detection system. (Note) Input signals CM2 0 0 1 1 CM1 0 1 0 1 Electronic gear numerator Parameter No.3 Parameter No.69 Parameter No.70 Parameter No.71
Control mode P S
Clear
CR
CN1-5
DI-1
CM1
DI-1
CM2
DI-1
Note. 0: CM1/CM2-VIN off (open) 1: CM1/CM2-VIN on (short) Gain changing CDP When using this signal, make it usable by the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. Connect CDP-VIN to change the load inertia moment ratio into the parameter No.61 setting and the gain values into the values multiplied by the parameter No.62 to 64 settings. <Position/internal speed control change mode> Used to select the control mode in the position/internal speed control change mode. (Note) LOP 0 1 Note. 0: LOP-VIN off (open) 1: LOP-VIN on (short) Forward rotation pulse train Reverse rotation pulse train PP NP PG NG CN1-23 CN1-25 CN1-22 CN1-24 Used to enter a command pulse train. In the open collector system (max. input frequency 200kpps). Forward rotation pulse train across PP-SG Reverse rotation pulse train across NP-SG In the differential receiver system (max. input frequency 500kpps). Forward rotation pulse train across PG-PP Reverse rotation pulse train across NG-NP The command pulse train form can be changed using parameter No.21. DI-2 Control mode Position Internal speed DI-1
Control change
LOP
DI-1
3 - 15
Ready In position
RD INP
CN1-11 CN1-10
DO-1 DO-1
Speed reached
SA
DO-1
ZSP MBR
DO-1 DO-1
Warning
WNG
DO-1
3 - 16
Functions/applications To use this signal, set " 1" in parameter No.49. This signal is output when an alarm occurs. When there is no alarm, respective ordinary signals (RD, INP, SA, ZSP) are output. Alarm codes and alarm names are listed below. Alarm CN1 CN1 CN1 display 12 Pin 11 Pin 10 Pin 88888 AL.12 AL.13 AL.15 0 0 0 AL.17 AL.19 AL.37 AL.8A AL.8E 0 0 1 0 0 1 AL.30 AL.33 AL.10 AL.45 0 1 1 AL.46 AL.50 AL.51 1 0 0 AL.24 AL.32 AL.31 1 1 0 AL.35 AL.52 AL.16 1 0 1 AL.1A AL.20 Note. 0: Pin-VIN off (open) 1: Pin-VIN on (short) Watchdog Memory error 1 Clock error Memory error 2 Board error Memory error 3 Parameter error Serial communication timeout Serial communication error Regenerative error Overvoltage Undervoltage Main circuit device Servo motor overheat Overload 1 Overload 2 Main circuit error Overcurrent Overspeed Command pulse frequency alarm Error excessive Encoder error 1 Monitor combination error Encoder error 2 (Note) Alarm code
Control mode P S
Name
3 - 17
Symbol OP
Functions/applications Outputs the zero-point signal of the encoder. One pulse is output per servo motor revolution. OP and LG are connected when the zero-point position is reached. (Negative logic) The minimum pulse width is about 400 s. For home position return using this pulse, set the creep speed to 100r/min. or less. Outputs pulses per servo motor revolution set in parameter No.27 in the differential line driver system. In CCW rotation of the servo motor, the encoder B-phase pulse lags the encoder A-phase pulse by a phase angle of /2. The relationships between rotation direction and phase difference of the Aand B-phase pulses can be changed using parameter No.54.
Control mode P S
Encoder A-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Encoder Z-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Analog monitor 1 Analog monitor 2
LA LAR
CN1-15 CN1-16
DO-2
LB LBR
CN1-17 CN1-18
LZ LZR
CN1-19 CN1-20
DO-2
MO1 MO2
CN3-4 CN3-6
Used to output the data set in parameter No.17 to across MO1-LG in terms of voltage. Resolution 10 bits Used to output the data set in parameter No.17 to across MO2-LG in terms of voltage. Resolution 10 bits
(3) Communication
Signal RS-232C I/F Symbol RXD TXD Connector pin No. CN3-1 CN3-2 Functions/applications RS-232C communication interface. I/O division Control mode P S
OPC SG LG SD
3 - 18
3.4 Detailed description of the signals 3.4.1 Position control mode (1) Pulse train input (a) Input pulse waveform selection Encoder pulses may be input in any of three different forms, for which positive or negative logic can be chosen. Set the command pulse train form in parameter No.21. Arrow or in the table indicates the timing of importing a pulse train. A- and B-phase pulse trains are imported after they have been multiplied by 4.
Pulse train form Forward rotation pulse train Reverse rotation pulse train Negative logic Forward rotation command Reverse rotation command
PP
0010
NP
PP
Pulse train
sign
NP L H
0011
PP
0012
Forward rotation pulse train Reverse rotation pulse train Positive logic
PP
0000
NP PP
Pulse train
sign
NP
0001
H L
PP
0002
NP
3 - 19
(b) Connections and waveforms 1) Open collector system Connect as shown below.
Servo amplifier External power supply 24VDC OPC
PP NP SG SD
(Note)
Note. Pulse train input interface is comprised of a photo coupler. Therefore, it may be any malfunctions since the current is reduced when connect a resistance to a pulse train signal line.
The explanation assumes that the input waveform has been set to the negative logic and forward and reverse rotation pulse trains (parameter No.21 has been set to 0010). The waveforms in the table in (1) (a) of this section are voltage waveforms of PP and NP based on SG. Their relationships with transistor ON/OFF are as follows.
Forward rotation pulse train (transistor) Reverse rotation pulse train (transistor)
(OFF) (ON) (OFF) (ON) (OFF)
(OFF)
3 - 20
Note. Pulse train input interface is comprised of a photo coupler. Therefore, it may be any malfunctions since the current is reduced when connect a resistance to a pulse train signal line.
The explanation assumes that the input waveform has been set to the negative logic and forward and reverse rotation pulse trains (parameter No.21 has been set to 0010). For the differential line driver, the waveforms in the table in (1) (a) of this section are as follows. The waveforms of PP, PG, NP and NG are based on that of the ground of the differential line driver.
Forward rotation pulse train
PP PG
Reverse rotation pulse train
3 - 21
(2) In-position (INP) PF-VIN are connected when the number of droop pulses in the deviation counter falls within the preset inposition range (parameter No.5). INP-VIN may remain connected when low-speed operation is performed with a large value set as the in-position range.
Servo-on (SON) ON OFF Yes No In-position range ON OFF
Alarm
Alarm
Ready (RD)
(4) Electronic gear switching The combination of CM1-VIN and CM2-VIN gives you a choice of four different electronic gear numerators set in the parameters. As soon as CM1/CM2 is turned ON or OFF, the numerator of the electronic gear changes. Therefore, if any shock occurs at this change, use position smoothing (parameter No.7) to relieve shock.
(Note) External input signal CM2 0 0 1 1 CM1 0 1 0 1 Electronic gear numerator Parameter No.3 Parameter No.69 Parameter No.70 Parameter No.71
3 - 22
(5) Torque limit Releasing the torque limit during servo lock may cause the servo motor to suddenly rotate according to the position deviation from the instructed position.
CAUTION
(a) Torque limit and torque By setting parameter No.28 (internal torque limit 1), torque is always limited to the maximum value during operation. A relationship between the limit value and servo motor torque is shown below.
Max. torque
(b) Torque limit value selection When internal torque limit selection (TL1) is made usable by parameter No.43 to 48, internal torque limit 2 (parameter No.76) can be selected. However, if the parameter No.28 value is less than the limit value selected by parameter No.76, the parameter No.28 value is made valid.
(Note) External input signals TL1 0 1 Note. 0: TL/TL1-VIN off (open) 1: TL/TL1-VIN on (short) Torque limit value made valid Internal torque limit value 1 (parameter No.28) Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.28 Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.76
3 - 23
3.4.2 Internal speed control mode (1) Speed setting (a) Speed command and speed The servo motor is run at the speeds set in the parameters.
The following table indicates the rotation direction according to forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) combination.
(Note 1) External input signals ST2 0 0 1 1 ST1 0 1 0 1 (Note 2) Rotation direction Internal speed commands Stop (Servo lock) CCW CW Stop (Servo lock)
Note 1. 0: ST1/ST2-VIN off (open) 1: ST1/ST2-VIN on (short) 2. Releasing the torque limit during servo lock may cause the servo motor to suddenly rotate according to the position deviation from the instructed position.
The forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) can be assigned to any pins of the connector CN1 using parameters No.43 to 48. Generally, make connection as shown below.
Servo amplifier ST1 ST2 VIN SD
3 - 24
(b) Speed selection 1 (SP1), speed selection 2 (SP2), speed selection 3 (SP3) and speed command value By making speed selection 1 (SP1), speed selection 2 (SP2) and speed selection 3 (SP3) usable by setting of parameter No.43 to 47, you can choose the speed command values of internal speed commands 1 to 7.
(Note) External input signals SP3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Speed command value Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed command 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed command 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed command 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed command 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed command 7 (parameter No.75)
The speed may be changed during rotation. In this case, the values set in parameters No.11 and 12 are used for acceleration/deceleration. When the speed has been specified under any internal speed command, it does not vary due to the ambient temperature. (2) Speed reached (SA) SA-VIN are connected when the servo motor speed nearly reaches the speed set to the internal speed command.
Set speed selection ON OFF
Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 2
ON OFF
3 - 25
3.4.3 Position/internal speed control change mode Set "0001" in parameter No.0 to switch to the position/internal speed control change mode. This function is not available in the absolute position detection system. (1) Control change (LOP) Use control change (LOP) to switch between the position control mode and the internal speed control mode from an external contact. Relationships between LOP-VIN status and control modes are indicated below.
(Note) LOP 0 1 Servo control mode Position control mode Speed control mode
The control mode may be changed in the zero-speed status. To ensure safety, change control after the servo motor has stopped. When position control mode is changed to speed control mode, droop pulses are reset. If the LOP has been switched on-off at the speed higher than the zero speed and the speed is then reduced to the zero speed or less, the control mode cannot be changed. A change timing chart is shown below.
Position control mode Zero speed level Internal speed control mode Position control mode
Note. When Zero speed (ZSP) is not on, control cannot be changed if Control change (LOP) is switched on-off. If Zero speed (ZSP) switches on after that, control cannot not be changed.
3 - 26
(3) Internal speed setting in speed control mode (a) Speed command and speed The servo motor is run at the speed set in parameter No.8 (internal speed command 1) the forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) are as in section 3.4.2 (1) (a). Generally, make connection as shown below.
Servo amplifier SP2 VIN SD
(b) Speed selection 2 (SP2) and speed command value Use speed selection 2 (SP2) to select between the speed set by the internal speed command 1 and the speed set by the Internal speed command 2 as indicated in the following table.
(Note) External input signals SP1 0 1 Note. 0: SP1-VIN off (open) 1: SP1-VIN on (short) Speed command value Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 2 (parameter No.9)
The speed may also be changed during rotation. In this case, it is increased or decreased according to the value set in parameter No.11 or 12. When the internal speed command 1 is used to command the speed, the speed does not vary with the ambient temperature. (c) Speed reached (SA) As in section 3.4.2 (2).
3 - 27
3.5 Alarm occurrence timing chart When an alarm has occurred, remove its cause, make sure that the operation signal is not being input, ensure safety, and reset the alarm before restarting operation. As soon as an alarm occurs, turn off Servo-on (SON) and power off the power supply. When an alarm occurs in the servo amplifier, the base circuit is shut off and the servo motor is coated to a stop. Switch off the power supply in the external sequence. To reset the alarm, switch the power supply from off to on, press the "SET" button on the current alarm screen, or turn the reset (RES) from off to on. However, the alarm cannot be reset unless its cause is removed.
(Note) Power supply
CAUTION
ON OFF Base circuit ON OFF Valid Dynamic brake Invalid Servo-on (SON) Ready (RD) Trouble (ALM) Reset (RES) ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Power off
Power on
Brake operation
Brake operation
2s Alarm occurs.
50ms or more 60ms or more
Remove cause of trouble. Note. Shut off the power as soon as an alarm occurs.
(1) Overcurrent, overload 1 or overload 2 If operation is repeated by switching power off, then on to reset the overcurrent (AL.32), overload 1 (AL.50) or overload 2 (AL.51) alarm after its occurrence, without removing its cause, the servo amplifier and servo motor may become faulty due to temperature rise. Securely remove the cause of the alarm and also allow about 30 minutes for cooling before resuming operation. (2) Regenerative error If operation is repeated by switching power off, then on to reset the regenerative (AL.30) alarm after its occurrence, the external regenerative resistor will generate heat, resulting in an accident. (3) Instantaneous power failure Undervoltage (AL.10) occurs when the input power is in either of the following statuses. A power failure of the control circuit power supply continues for 60ms or longer and the control circuit is not completely off. The bus voltage dropped to 200VDC. (4) In position control mode (incremental) When an alarm occurs, the home position is lost. When resuming operation after deactivating the alarm, make a home position return.
3 - 28
3.6 Interfaces 3.6.1 Common line The following diagram shows the power supply and its common line.
CN1 External power supply 24VDC DI-1 SG (Note) OPC
PG NG PP NP
SG
OP LG LA etc.
LAR etc.
Note. For the open collection pulse train input. Make the following connection for the different line driver pulse train input.
OPC PG PP SG NG NP
3 - 29
3.6.2 Detailed description of the interfaces This section gives the details of the I/O signal interfaces (refer to I/O Division in the table) indicated in section 3.3.2. Refer to this section and connect the interfaces with the external equipment. (1) Digital input interface DI-1 Give a signal with a relay or open collector transistor.
Servo amplifier
VIN
SON, etc.
R: Approx. 4.7k
(2) Digital output interface DO-1 A lamp, relay or photocoupler can be driven. Provide a diode (D) for an inductive load, or an inrush current suppressing resistor (R) for a lamp load. (Rated current: 40mA or less, maximum current: 50mA or less, inrush current: 100mA or less) (a) Inductive load
Servo amplifier
ALM, etc. SG
Note. If the voltage drop (maximum of 2.6V) interferes with the relay operation, apply high voltage (up to 26.4V) from external source.
3 - 30
Note. If the voltage drop (maximum of 2.6V) interferes with the relay operation, apply high voltage (up to 26.4V) from external source.
(3) Pulse train input interface DI-2 Provide a pulse train signal in the open collector or differential line driver system. (a) Open collector system 1) Interface
Servo amplifier
OPC
2m (78.74in) or less
PP, NP
SG SD
Note. Pulse train input interface is comprised of a photo coupler. Therefore, it may be any malfunctions since the current is reduced when connect a resistance to a pulse train signal line.
NP
3 - 31
10m or less
Note. Pulse train input interface is comprised of a photo coupler. Therefore, it may be any malfunctions since the current is reduced when connect a resistance to a pulse train signal line.
OP LG SD
OP LG SD Photocoupler
3 - 32
2) Output pulse
Servo motor CCW rotation LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP /2 T Time cycle (T) is determined by the settings of parameter No.27 and 54.
400 s or more
(5) Analog output Output voltage 10V Max. 1mA Max. output current Resolution: 10bit
Servo amplifier
MO1 (MO2)
LG SD
3 - 33
3.7 Input power supply circuit Always connect a magnetic contactor (MC) between the main circuit power supply and L1, L2, and L3 of the servo amplifier, and configure the wiring to be able to shut down the power supply on the side of the servo amplifiers power supply. If a magnetic contactor (MC) is not connected, continuous flow of a large current may cause a fire when the servo amplifier malfunctions. Use the trouble (ALM) to switch power off. Otherwise, a regenerative transistor fault or the like may overheat the regenerative resistor, causing a fire. POINT The power supply connector (CNP1) is optional. Purchase it without fail. 3.7.1 Connection example Wire the power supply and main circuit as shown below so that the servo-on (SON) turns off as soon as alarm occurrence is detected and power is shut off. A circuit breaker (NFB) must be used with the input cables of the power supply. (1) For 3-phase 200 to 230VAC power supply
Emergency stop OFF RA ON MC MC SK NFB 3-phase 200 to 230 VAC MC CNP1 Servo amplifier L1 L2 L3 (Note) P D C Emergency stop Servo-on EMG SON VIN VIN ALM SG RA External power Trouble supply 24VDC
CAUTION
Note. To use the built-in regenerative resistor, be sure to connect across P and D of the power supply connector (CNP1).
3 - 34
Note. To use the built-in regenerative resistor, be sure to connect across P and D of the power supply connector (CNP1).
3.7.2 Terminals Refer to section 11.1 (4) for the signal arrangement.
Connected terminal (Application) Symbol Description Supply L1, L2 and L3 with the following power. For 1-phase 230VAC, connect the power supply to L1, L2 and L3 open. Servo amplifier Power supply Power supply L2 3-phase 200 to 230VAC, 50/60Hz 1-phase 230VAC, 50/60Hz L1 L2 MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-70A-QW003 L1 MR-E-100A-QW003/ MR-E-200A-QW003 L2 L3
L1
Connect to the servo motor power terminals (U, V, W). During power-on, do not open or close the motor power line. Otherwise, a malfunction or faulty may occur. To use the built-in regenerative resistor of the servo amplifier, connect the wiring across P-D of the power supply connector (CNP1). When using the regenerative option, always remove the wiring from across P-D and connect the regenerative option across P-C. Refer to section 13.1.1 for details. Connect this terminal to the protective earth (PE) terminals of the servo motor and control box for grounding.
3 - 35
3.7.3 Power-on sequence (1) Power-on procedure 1) Always wire the power supply as shown in above section 3.7.1 using the magnetic contactor with the power supply (three-phase 200V: L1, L2, L3, single-phase 230V: L1, L2). Configure up an external sequence to switch off the magnetic contactor as soon as an alarm occurs. 2) The servo amplifier can accept the servo-on (SON) 2s or more after the power supply is switched on. Therefore, when SON is switched on simultaneously with the power supply, the base circuit will switch on in about 1 to 2s, and the ready (RD) will switch on in further about 20ms, making the servo amplifier ready to operate. (Refer to paragraph (2) in this section.) 3) When the reset (RES) is switched on, the base circuit is shut off and the servo motor shaft coasts. (2) Timing chart
SON accepted
2s or longer (1 to 2s)
power supply Base circuit Servo-on (SON) Reset (RES) Ready (RD)
10ms
10ms
60ms
60ms
20ms
10ms
20ms
10ms
20ms
10ms
CAUTION
Provide an external emergency stop circuit to ensure that operation can be stopped and power switched off immediately.
Make up a circuit which shuts off power as soon as EMG-VIN are opened at an emergency stop. To ensure safety, always install an external emergency stop switch across EMG-VIN. By disconnecting EMG-VIN, the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. At this time, the display shows the servo emergency stop warning (AL.E6). During ordinary operation, do not use the external emergency stop signal to alternate stop and run. The servo amplifier life may be shortened. Also, if the start signal is on or a pulse train is input during an emergency stop, the servo motor will rotate as soon as the warning is reset. During an emergency stop, always shut off the run command.
VIN
Emergency stop
EMG SG
3 - 36
3.8 Connection of servo amplifier and servo motor 3.8.1 Connection instructions
WARNING
Insulate the connections of the power supply terminals to prevent an electric shock. Connect the wires to the correct phase terminals (U, V, W) of the servo amplifier and servo motor. Otherwise, the servo motor does not operate properly.
CAUTION
Do not connect AC power supply directly to the servo motor. Otherwise, a fault may occur. During power-on, do not open or close the motor power line. Otherwise, a malfunction or faulty may occur. POINT Refer to section 12.1 for the selection of the encoder cable. The connector (CNP2) for supplying the power to the motor is optional. Be sure to purchase it.
The connection method differs according to the series and capacity of the servo motor and whether or not the servo motor has the electromagnetic brake. Perform wiring in accordance with this section. (1) For grounding, connect the earth cable of the servo motor to the protective earth (PE) terminal ( ) of the servo amplifier and connect the ground cable of the servo amplifier to the earth via the protective earth (PE) terminal of the control box. Do not connect them directly to the protective earth of the control panel.
Control box Servo amplifier Servo motor
PE terminal
(2) Do not share the 24VDC interface power supply between the interface and electromagnetic brake. Always use the power supply designed exclusively for the electromagnetic brake.
3 - 37
3.8.2 Power supply cable wiring diagrams (1) HF-KE W1-S100 Servo motor (a) When cable length is 10m or less
10m or less MR-PWS1CBL MR-PWS1CBL MR-PWS1CBL MR-PWS1CBL AWG 19 (red) AWG 19 (white) AWG 19 (black) AWG 19 (green/yellow) M-A1-L M-A2-L M-A1-H M-A2-H
Servo motor U V W M
(Note 3)
Electromagnetic brake interlock Trouble Emergency stop (EMG) (ALM) (MBR)
(Note 2)
AWG20 AWG20
(Note 1)
Note 1. Connect a surge absorber as close to the servo motor as possible. 2. There is no polarity in electromagnetic brake terminals (B1 and B2). 3. When using a servo motor with electromagnetic brake, assign the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) to external output signal in the parameters No.PA04, PD13 to PD16 and PD18.
3 - 38
(b) Connector and signal allotment When the cable length exceeds 10m, fabricate an extension cable as shown below. In this case, the motor power supply cable should be within 2m long. Refer to section 13.1.2 for the wire used for the extension cable.
50m or less 2m or less
MR-PWS1CBL2M-A1-L MR-PWS1CBL2M-A2-L MR-PWS1CBL2M-A1-H MR-PWS1CBL2M-A2-H MR-PWS2CBL03M-A1-L Servo motor MR-PWS2CBL03M-A2-L
U V W M
(Note 1) (Note 1) a) Relay connector b) Relay connector for for extension cable motor power supply cable 2m or less 24VDC power supply for electromagnetic (Note 4) brake Electromagnetic
brake interlock (MBR) MR-BKS1CBL2M-A1-L MR-BKS1CBL2M-A2-L MR-BKS1CBL2M-A1-H MR-BKS1CBL2M-A2-H MR-BKS2CBL03M-A1-L MR-BKS2CBL03M-A2-L
(Note 3) B1 B2
AWG20 AWG20
(Note 2)
Note 1. Use of the following connectors is recommended when ingress protection (IP65) is necessary. Relay Connector Description Protective Structure IP65
Connector: RM15WTPZ-4P(71) a) Relay connector for Cord clamp: RM15WTP-CP(5)(71) extension cable (Hirose Electric) Numeral changes depending on the cable OD. b) Relay connector for Connector: RM15WTJA-4S(71) motor power supply Cord clamp: RM15WTP-CP(8)(71) Numeral changes depending on the cable OD. (Hirose Electric) cable
IP65
c) Relay connector for CM10-CR2P(DDK) extension cable d) Relay connector for CM10-SP2Smotor brake cable (DDK)
IP65
Wire size: S, M, L
IP65
Wire size: S, M, L
2. Connect a surge absorber as close to the servo motor as possible. 3. There is no polarity in electromagnetic brake terminals (B1 and B2). 4. When using a servo motor with electromagnetic brake, assign the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) to external output signal in the parameters No.PA04, PD13 to PD16 and PD18.
3 - 39
(2) HF-SE JW1-S100 servo motor (a) Wiring diagrams Refer to section 13.2 for the cables used for wiring.
50m or less Servo amplifier CNP2 U V W Servo motor U V W
(Note 2)
Electromagnetic brake interlock Trouble Emergency (MBR) (ALM) stop RA2 RA1 (EMG)
B1 B2
(Note 1)
Note 1. There is no polarity in electromagnetic brake terminals B1 and B2. 2. When using a servo motor with electromagnetic brake, assign the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) to external output signal in the parameters No.1.
(b) Connector and signal allotment The connector fitting the servo motor is prepared as optional equipment. Refer to section 13.1.2. For types other than those prepared as optional equipment, refer to chapter.
Servo motor side connectors Servo motor HF-SE52JW1-S100 HF-SE102JW1-S100 HF-SE152JW1-S100 HF-SE202JW1-S100
a c b
Encoder
Power supply
MS3102A20-29P
MS3102A18-10P MS3102A22-22P
Detector connector signal allotment MS3102A20-29P Pin A B C D E F G H J Signal MD MDR MR MRR Pin K L M N P R S T P5G P5E CONT SHD Signal
L K J
A B C N D T P E S R G F
Signal U V W (Earth)
View c
C B
D A
1 2
View a
Note. For the motor with electromagnetic brake, supply electromagnetic brake power (24VDC). There is no polarity.
3 - 40
3.9 Servo motor with electromagnetic brake 3.9.1 Precautions Configure the electromagnetic brake operation circuit so that it is activated not only by the servo amplifier signals but also by an external emergency stop (EMG).
Contacts must be open when servo-off, when an trouble (ALM) and when an electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR). SON RA Circuit must be opened during emergency stop (EMG).
EMG 24VDC
CAUTION
Electromagnetic brake
The electromagnetic brake is provided for holding purpose and must not be used for ordinary braking. Before performing the operation, be sure to confirm that the electromagnetic brake operates properly. POINT Refer to chapter 14 for specifications such as the power supply capacity and operation delay time of the electromagnetic brake. Refer to section 3.8 for wiring diagrams. Note the following when the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake is used. 1) Set " 1 " in parameter No.1 to make the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) valid. Note that this will make the zero speed signal (ZSP) unavailable. 2) Do not share the 24VDC interface power supply between the interface and electromagnetic brake. Always use the power supply designed exclusively for the electromagnetic brake. 3) The brake will operate when the power (24VDC) switches off. 4) While the reset (RES) is on, the base circuit is shut off. When using the servo motor with a vertical shaft, use the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR). 5) Switch off the servo-on signal after the servo motor has stopped. 3.9.2 Setting 1) Set " 1 " in parameter No.1 to make the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) valid. 2) Using parameter No.33 (electromagnetic brake sequence output), set a delay time (Tb) at servo-off from electromagnetic brake operation to base circuit shut-off as in the timing chart shown in section 3.9.3.
3 - 41
3.9.3 Timing charts (1) Servo-on signal command (from controller) ON/OFF Tb [ms] after the servo-on (SON) signal is switched off, the servo lock is released and the servo motor coasts. If the electromagnetic brake is made valid in the servo lock status, the brake life may be shorter. Therefore, when using the electromagnetic brake in a vertical lift application or the like, set Delay time (Tb) to about the same as the electromagnetic brake operation delay time to prevent a drop.
Coasting Servo motor speed 0 r/min (60ms) Base circuit ON OFF Invalid(ON) Valid(OFF) ON OFF (80ms) Electromagnetic brake operation delay time Tb
Servo motor speed (10ms) Base circuit Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) Emergency stop (EMG) ON OFF Invalid (ON) Valid (OFF) Invalid (ON) Valid (OFF)
(180ms)
Electromagnetic brake operation delay time
3 - 42
Base circuit
ON OFF
Invalid(ON) Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) Valid(OFF) Trouble (ALM) No(ON) Yes(OFF)
Base circuit
Invalid(ON) Electromagnetic brake interlock(MBR) Valid(OFF) Trouble (ALM) No(ON) Yes(OFF) ON OFF Electromagnetic brake operation delay time (Note 2)
Power
3 - 43
3.10 Grounding Ground the servo amplifier and servo motor securely.
WARNING
To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier with the protective earth (PE) of the control box.
The servo amplifier switches the power transistor on-off to supply power to the servo motor. Depending on the wiring and ground cable routing, the servo amplifier may be affected by the switching noise (due to di/dt and dv/dt) of the transistor. To prevent such a fault, refer to the following diagram and always ground. To conform to the EMC Directive, refer to the EMC Installation Guidelines (IB(NA)67310).
Control box Servo motor NFB Line filter MC Servo amplifier L1 (Note) Power supply Encoder L2 L3 U V W CN1 U V W M CN2
Programmable controllers
Ensure to connect it to PE terminal of the servo amplifier. Do not connect it directly to the protective earth of the control panel.
Protective earth(PE)
Outer box
Note. For 1-phase 230VAC, connect the power supply to L1, L2 and leave L3 open. Refer to section 1.3 for the power supply specification.
3 - 44
3.11 Servo amplifier connectors (CNP1, CNP2) wiring method (When MR-ECPN1-B and MR-ECPN2-B of an option are used.) POINT For the wire sizes used for wiring, refer to Table 13.1 1), 2) and 3) of section 13.2.1. (1) Termination of the cables Solid wire: After the sheath has been stripped, the cable can be used as it is.
8 to 9 mm
Twisted wire: Use the cable after stripping the sheath and twisting the core. At this time, take care to avoid a short caused by the loose wires of the core and the adjacent pole. Do not solder the core as it may cause a contact fault.
3 - 45
(2) Inserting the cable into the connector (a) Applicable flat-blade screwdriver dimensions Always use the screwdriver shown here to do the work. [Unit: mm]
(R0.3) 0.6 (22) 3
(R0.3) 3 to 3.5
1) Insert the screwdriver into the square hole. Insert it along the top of the square hole to insert it smoothly.
3) With the screwdriver held, insert the cable in the direction of arrow. (Insert the cable as far as it will go.)
3 - 46
1) Insert the screwdriver into the square window at top of the connector.
3) With the screwdriver pushed, insert the cable in the direction of arrow. (Insert the cable as far as it will go.)
3 - 47
3.12 Instructions for the 3M connector When fabricating an encoder cable or the like, securely connect the shielded external conductor of the cable to the ground plate as shown in this section and fix it to the connector shell.
External conductor
Sheath
Core Sheath External conductor Pull back the external conductor to cover the sheath
Cable
3 - 48
4. OPERATION
4. OPERATION
4.1 When switching power on for the first time Before starting operation, check the following. (1) Wiring (a) A correct power supply is connected to the power input terminals (L1, L2, L3) of the servo amplifier. (b) The servo motor power supply terminals (U, V, W) of the servo amplifier match in phase with the power input terminals (U, V, W) of the servo motor. (c) The servo motor power supply terminals (U, V, W) of the servo amplifier are not shorted to the power input terminals (L1, L2, L3) of the servo motor. (d) The earth terminal of the servo motor is connected to the PE terminal of the servo amplifier. (e) When using the regenerative option, the lead has been removed from across D-P of the servo amplifier built-in regenerative resistor, and twisted cables are used for its wiring. (f) When stroke end limit switches are used, the signals across LSP-VIN and LSN-VIN are on during operation. (g) 24VDC or higher voltages are not applied to the pins of connectors CN1. (h) SD and SG of connectors CN1 are not shorted. (i) The wiring cables are free from excessive force. (2) Environment Signal cables and power cables are not shorted by wire offcuts, metallic dust or the like. (3) Machine (a) The screws in the servo motor installation part and shaft-to-machine connection are tight. (b) The servo motor and the machine connected with the servo motor can be operated.
4- 1
4. OPERATION
4.2 Startup
WARNING
Do not operate the switches with wet hands. You may get an electric shock. Before starting operation, check the parameters. Some machines may perform unexpected operation. Take safety measures, e.g. provide covers, to prevent accidental contact of hands and parts (cables, etc.) with the servo amplifier heat sink, regenerative resistor, servo motor, etc. since they may be hot while power is on or for some time after power-off. Their temperatures may be high and you may get burnt or a parts may damaged. During operation, never touch the rotating parts of the servo motor. Doing so can cause injury.
CAUTION
Connect the servo motor with a machine after confirming that the servo motor operates properly alone. 4.2.1 Selection of control mode Use parameter No.0 to choose the control mode used. After setting, this parameter is made valid by switching power off, then on. 4.2.2 Position control mode (1) Power on 1) Switch off the servo-on (SON). 2) When power is switched on, the display shows "C (Cumulative feedback pulses)", and in two second later, shows data. (2) Test operation 1 Confirm servo motor operation by operating JOG of test operation mode at lowest speed possible. (Refer to section 6.8.2) (3) Parameter setting Set the parameters according to the structure and specifications of the machine. Refer to chapter 5 for the parameter definitions and to section 6.5 for the setting method.
Parameter No. 0 Name Control mode, regenerative option selection 0 1 Function selection 1 Setting 3 0 Position control mode MR-RB12 regenerative option is used. 02 Input filter 3.555ms (initial value) Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) is not used. Used in incremental positioning system. 1 2 3 4 Auto tuning Electronic gear numerator (CMX) Electronic gear denominator (CDV) 1 1 5 Middle response (initial value) is selected. Auto tuning mode 1 is selected. Electronic gear numerator Electronic gear denominator Description
Turn the power off after setting parameters No.0 and 1. Then switch power on again to make the set parameter values valid.
4- 2
4. OPERATION
(4) Servo-on Switch the servo-on in the following procedure. 1) Switch on power supply. 2) Switch on the servo-on (SON). When placed in the servo-on status, the servo amplifier is ready to operate and the servo motor is locked. (5) Command pulse input Entry of a pulse train from the positioning device rotates the servo motor. At first, run it at lowest speed possible and check the rotation direction, etc. If it does not run in the intended direction, check the input signal. On the status display, check the speed, command pulse frequency, load factor, etc. of the servo motor. When machine operation check is over, check automatic operation with the program of the positioning device. This servo amplifier has a real-time auto tuning function under model adaptive control. Performing operation automatically adjusts gains. The optimum tuning results are provided by setting the response level appropriate for the machine in parameter No.2. (Refer to chapter 7) (6) Home position return Make home position return as required. (7) Stop In any of the following statuses, the servo amplifier interrupts and stops the operation of the servo motor. Refer to section 3.9 for the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake. Note that the stop pattern of forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) OFF is as described below. (a) Servo-on (SON) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the servo motor coasts. (b) Alarm occurrence When an alarm occurs, the base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. (c) Emergency stop (EMG) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. Alarm AL.E6 (servo emergency stop warning) occurs. (d) Forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) OFF The droop pulse value is erased and the servo motor is stopped and servo-locked. It can be run in the opposite direction.
4- 3
4. OPERATION
4.2.3 Internal speed control mode (1) Power on 1) Switch off the servo-on (SON). 2) When circuit power is switched on, the display shows "r (servo motor speed)", and in two second later, shows data. (2) Test operation Using jog operation in the test operation mode, make sure that the servo motor operates. (Refer to section 6.8.2.) (3) Parameter setting Set the parameters according to the structure and specifications of the machine. Refer to chapter 5 for the parameter definitions and to section 6.5 for the setting method.
Parameter No. 0 Name Control mode, regenerative option selection Setting 0 2 Internal speed control mode Regenerative option is not used. 12 1 Function selection 1 1 2 8 9 10 11 12 13 Auto tuning Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Acceleration time constant Deceleration time constant S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant 1000 1500 2000 1000 500 0 5 Middle response (initial value) is selected. Auto tuning mode 1 is selected. Set 1000r/min. Set 1500r/min. Set 2000r/min. Set 1000ms. Set 500ms. Not used Input filter 3.555ms (initial value) Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) is used. Description
Turn the power off after setting parameters No.0 and 1. Then switch power on again to make the set parameter values valid. (4) Servo-on Switch the servo-on in the following procedure. 1) Switch on circuit power supply. 2) Switch on the servo-on (SON) signal. (Short between SON and VIN.) When placed in the servo-on status, the servo amplifier is ready to operate and the servo motor is locked.
4- 4
4. OPERATION
(5) Start Using speed selection 1 (SP1) and speed selection 2 (SP2), choose the servo motor speed. Turn on forward rotation start (ST1) to run the motor in the forward rotation (CCW) direction or reverse rotation start (ST2) to run it in the reverse rotation (CW) direction. At first, set a low speed and check the rotation direction, etc. If it does not run in the intended direction, check the input signal. On the status display, check the speed, load factor, etc. of the servo motor. When machine operation check is over, check automatic operation with the host controller or the like. This servo amplifier has a real-time auto tuning function under model adaptive control. Performing operation automatically adjusts gains. The optimum tuning results are provided by setting the response level appropriate for the machine in parameter No.2. (Refer to chapter 7) (6) Stop In any of the following statuses, the servo amplifier interrupts and stops the operation of the servo motor. Refer to section 3.9 for the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake. Note that simultaneous ON or simultaneous OFF of forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) OFF and forward rotation start (ST1) or reverse rotation start (ST2) signal has the same stop pattern as described below. (a) Servo-on (SON) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the servo motor coasts. (b) Alarm occurrence When an alarm occurs, the base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. (c) Emergency stop (EMG) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. Alarm AL.E6 (servo emergency stop warning) occurs. (d) Forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) OFF The servo motor is brought to a sudden stop and servo-locked. The motor may be run in the opposite direction. (e) Simultaneous ON or simultaneous OFF of forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) signals The servo motor is decelerated to a stop. POINT A sudden stop indicates deceleration to a stop at the deceleration time constant of zero.
4- 5
4. OPERATION
MEMO
4- 6
5. PARAMETERS
5. PARAMETERS CAUTION
5.1 Parameter list 5.1.1 Parameter write inhibit POINT After setting the parameter No.19 value, switch power off, then on to make that setting valid. This servo amplifier, its parameters are classified into the basic parameters (No.0 to 19), expansion parameters 1 (No.20 to 49) and expansion parameters 2 (No.50 to 84) according to their safety aspects and frequencies of use. In the factory setting condition, the customer can change the basic parameter values but cannot change the expansion parameter values. When fine adjustment, e.g. gain adjustment, is required, change the parameter No.19 setting to make the expansion parameters write-enabled. The following table indicates the parameters which are enabled for reference and write by the setting of parameter No.19. Operation can be performed for the parameters marked .
Parameter No.19 setting 0000 (initial value) 000A 000B 000C 000E 100B 100C 100E Operation Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write No.19 only No.19 only No.19 only No.19 only No.19 only Basic parameters No.0 to 19 Expansion parameters 1 No.20 to 49 Expansion parameters 2 No.50 to 84
Never adjust or change the parameter values extremely as it will make operation instable.
5- 1
5. PARAMETERS
5.1.2 Lists POINT For any parameter whose symbol is preceded by *, set the parameter value and switch power off once, then switch it on again to make that parameter setting valid. The symbols in the control mode column of the table indicate the following modes. P: Position control mode S: Internal speed control mode (1) Item list
No. Symbol 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Basic parameters 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 *SNO *BPS MOD *DMD *BLK *STY *OP1 ATU CMX CDV INP PG1 PST SC1 SC2 SC3 STA STB STC Name Control mode, regenerative option selection Function selection 1 Auto tuning Electronic gear numerator Electronic gear denominator In-position range Position loop gain 1 Position command acceleration/deceleration time constant (Position smoothing) Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 2 Internal speed command 3 Acceleration time constant Deceleration time constant S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant For manufacturer setting Station number setting Serial communication function selection, alarm history clear Analog monitor output Status display selection Parameter write inhibit P S P S P S P S P S Control mode P S P S P S P P P P P S S S S S S Initial value (Note 1) 0002 0105 1 1 100 35 3 100 500 1000 0 0 0 0 0 0000 0100 0000 0000 station pulse rad/s ms r/min r/min r/min ms ms ms Unit Customer setting
5- 2
5. PARAMETERS
Name
Control mode P S P P S P P S
Unit
Customer setting
Function selection 3 (Command pulse selection) Function selection 4 Feed forward gain Zero speed For manufacturer setting For manufacturer setting
r/min
100 P S P S 4000 100 0 0 P S P S P S P S P P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S P S 0 0 100 70 35 177 817 48 980 0 0000 0002 0111 0882 0995 0000 0000 0403 0000 mV mV ms Multiplier ( 10 1) rad/s rad/s rad/s ms pulse /rev
*ENR TL1
Encoder output pulses Internal torque limit 1 For manufacturer setting For manufacturer setting
MO1 MO2 MBR GD2 PG2 VG1 VG2 VIC VDC *DIA *DI1 *DI2 *DI3 *DI4 *DI5 *DI6 *LSPN *DO1
Analog monitor 1 offset Analog monitor 2 offset Electromagnetic brake sequence output Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position loop gain 2 Speed loop gain 1 Speed loop gain 2 Speed integral compensation Speed differential compensation For manufacturer setting Input signal automatic ON selection Input signal selection 1 Input signal selection 2 (CN1-4) Input signal selection 3 (CN1-3) Input signal selection 4 (CN1-5) Input signal selection 5 (CN1-6) Input signal selection 6 (CN1-7) LSP/LSN input terminals selection Output signal selection 1
5- 3
5. PARAMETERS
Symbol For manufacturer setting *OP6 *OP8 *OP9 *OPA SIC NH1 NH2 LPF GD2B PG2B VG2B VICB *CDP CDS CDT CMX2 CMX3 CMX4 SC4 SC5 SC6 SC7 TL2 Function selection 6 For manufacturer setting Function selection 8 Function selection 9 Function selection A
Name
Control mode P S P S P S P P S P S P S P S P S P P S P S P S P S P S P P P S S S S P S
Initial value 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0 10 0000 0000 0000 70 100 100 100 0000 10 1 0 1 1 1 200 300 500 800 100 100 10000 10 10 100 100 100 0000
Unit
Customer setting
Serial communication time-out selection For manufacturer setting Machine resonance suppression filter 1 Machine resonance suppression filter 2 Low-pass filter/adaptive vibration suppression control Ratio of load inertia moment to Servo motor inertia moment 2 Position control gain 2 changing ratio Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Speed integral compensation changing ratio Gain changing selection Gain changing condition Gain changing time constant For manufacturer setting Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 2 Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 3 Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 4 Internal speed command 4 Internal speed command 5 Internal speed command 6 Internal speed command 7 Internal torque limit 2 For manufacturer setting
Multiplier ( 10 1)
(Note 2) ms
Note 1. Depends on the capacity of the servo amplifier. 2. Depends on the parameter No.65 setting.
5- 4
5. PARAMETERS
Select the control mode. 0: Position 1: Position and internal speed 2: Internal speed Motor series selection 0: HF-KE W1-S100 1: HF-SE JW1-S100 Selection of regenerative option 0: Regenerative option is not used For the servo amplifier of 200W or lower, regenerative resistor is not used. For the servo amplifier of 400W or higher, built-in regenerative resistor is used. 2: MR-RB032 3: MR-RB12 4: MR-RB32 5: MR-RB30 6: MR-RB50 (Cooling fan is required) Motor capacity selection 0: 100W 1: 200W 2: 400W 3: 500W 4: 750W 5: 1kW 6: 1.5kW 7: 2kW
Basic parameters
POINT Wrong setting may cause the regenerative option to burn. If the regenerative option selected is not for use with the servo amplifier, parameter error (AL.37) occurs. 1 *OP1 Function selection 1 Used to select the input signal filter, the function of pin CN1-12. 0002 Refer to name and function column. P S
0 0
Input signal filter If external input signal causes chattering due to noise, etc., input filter is used to suppress it. 0: None 1: 1.777[ms] 2: 3.555[ms] 3: 5.333[ms] CN1-12 function selection 0: Zero Speed detection signal 1: Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR)
5- 5
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 2
Symbol ATU
Name and function Auto tuning Used to selection the response level, etc. for execution of auto tuning. Refer to chapter 7.
Unit
Control mode P S
0
Auto tuning response level setting Set Response Machine resonance value level frequency guideline Low 1 15Hz response 2 20Hz 25Hz 3 4 30Hz 5 35Hz 6 45Hz 55Hz 7 Middle 8 70Hz response 9 85Hz A 105Hz B 130Hz 160Hz C D 200Hz High E 240Hz response F 300Hz If the machine hunts or generates large gear sound, decrease the set value. To improve performance, e.g. shorten the settling time, increase the set value. Gain adjustment mode selection (For more information, refer to section 7.1.1.) Set Gain adjustment mode Description value Interpolation mode Fixes position control gain 1 0 (parameter No.6). 1 2 Auto tuning mode 1 Auto tuning mode 2 Ordinary auto tuning. Fixes the load inertia moment ratio set in parameter No.34. Response level setting can be changed. Simple manual adjustment. Manual adjustment of all gains.
Basic parameters
3 4
CMX
Electronic gear numerator Used to set the electronic gear numerator value. For the setting, refer to section 5.2.1. Setting "0" automatically sets the resolution of the servo motor connected. Electronic gear denominator Used to set the electronic gear denominator value. For the setting, refer to section 5.2.1.
0 1 to 65535 1 to 65535
CDV
5- 6
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 5
Symbol INP
Name and function In-position range Used to set the in-position signal (INP) output range in the command pulse increments prior to electronic gear calculation. Position loop gain 1 Used to set the gain of position loop. Increase the gain to improve track ability in response to the position command. When auto turning mode 1,2 is selected, the result of auto turning is automatically used. Position command acceleration/deceleration time constant (position smoothing) Used to set the time constant of a low-pass filter in response to the position command. You can use parameter No.55 to choose the primary delay or linear acceleration/deceleration control system. When you choose linear acceleration/deceleration, the setting range is 0 to 10ms. Setting of longer than 10ms is recognized as 10ms. POINT When you have chosen linear acceleration/deceleration, do not select control selection (parameter No.0) and restart after instantaneous power failure (parameter No.20). Doing so will cause the servo motor to make a sudden stop at the time of position control switching or restart. Example: When a command is given from a synchronizing detector, synchronous operation can be started smoothly if started during line operation.
Unit pulse
Control mode P
PG1
35
red/s
PST
ms
0 to 20000
Basic parameters
Synchronizing detector
Start
Start
SC1
100
r/min
5- 7
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 9
Symbol SC2
Name and function Internal speed command 2 Used to set speed 2 of internal speed commands.
Unit r/min
10
SC3
1000
r/min
11
STA
Acceleration time constant Used to set the acceleration time required to reach the rated speed from 0r/min in response to the internal speed commands 1 to 7.
If the preset speed command is lower than the rated speed, acceleration/deceleration time will be shorter.
ms
Setting Control range mode 0 to S instantaneous permissible speed 0 to S instantaneous permissible speed 0 S to 20000
Zero speed
Basic parameters
12
STB
For example for the servo motor of 3000r/min rated speed, set 3000 (3s) to increase speed from 0r/min to 1000r/min in 1 second. Deceleration time constant Used to set the deceleration time required to reach 0r/min from the rated speed in response to the internal speed commands 1 to 7. S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant Used to smooth start/stop of the servo motor. Set the time of the arc part for S-pattern acceleration/deceleration.
Speed command Speed Servo motor
13
STC
ms
0 to 1000
Time
STA: Acceleration time constant (parameter No.11) STB: Deceleration time constant (parameter No.12) STC: S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant (parameter No.13)
Long setting of STA (acceleration time constant) or STB (deceleration time constant) may produce an error in the time of the arc part for the setting of the S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant.
The upper limit value of the actual arc part time is limited by 2000000 2000000 for acceleration or by for deceleration. STA STB (Example) At the setting of STA 20000, STB 5000 and STC 200, the actual arc part times are as follows. During acceleration: 100[ms] Limited to 100[ms] since 2000000 100[ms] 200[ms]. 20000 200[ms] as set since During deceleration: 200[ms] 2000000 5000 400[ms] 200[ms].
5- 8
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 14
Symbol
Name and function For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Initial value 0
Unit
Setting range
Control mode
15
*SNO
Station number setting Used to specify the station number for serial communication. Always set one station to one axis of servo amplifier. If one station number is set to two or more stations, normal communication cannot be made. Serial communication function selection, alarm history clear Used to select the serial communication baud rate, select various communication conditions, and clear the alarm history.
station
P S
16
*BPS
0000
P S
0
Serial baud rate selection 0: 9600 [bps] 1: 19200[bps] 2: 38400[bps] 3: 57600[bps] Alarm history clear 0: Invalid (not cleared) 1: Valid (cleared) When alarm history clear is made valid, the alarm history is cleared at next power-on. After the alarm history is cleared, the setting is automatically made invalid (reset to 0).
Basic parameters
Serial communication response delay time 0: Invalid 1: Valid, reply sent after delay time of 800 s or more
17
MOD
Analog monitor output Used to selection the signal provided to the analog monitor (MO1) monitor (MO2) output. (Refer to section 5.2.2.)
0100 analog
P S
Setting Analog monitor 2 (MO2) Analog monitor 1 (MO1) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B Servo motor speed ( 8V/max. speed) Torque ( 8V/max. torque) Servo motor speed ( 8V/max. speed) Torque ( 8V/max. torque) Current command ( 8V/max. current command) Command pulse frequency ( 10V/500kpulse/s) Droop pulses ( 10V/128 pulses) Droop pulses ( 10V/2048 pulses) Droop pulses ( 10V/8192 pulses) Droop pulses ( 10V/32768 pulses) Droop pulses ( 10V/131072 pulses) Bus voltage ( 8V/400V)
5- 9
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 18
Symbol *DMD
Name and function Status display selection Used to select the status display shown at power-on.
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0
Selection of status display at power-on 0: Cumulative feedback pulses 1: Servo motor speed 2: Droop pulses 3: Cumulative command pulses 4: Command pulse frequency 7: Regenerative load ratio 8: Effective load ratio 9: Peak load ratio A: Instantaneous torque B: Within one-revolution position low C: Within one-revolution position high D: Load inertia moment ratio E: Bus voltage Status display at power-on in corresponding control mode 0: Depends on the control mode. Control mode Position Position/ internal speed Internal speed Status display at power-on Cumulative feedback pulses Cumulative feedback pulses/ servo motor speed Servo motor speed
Basic parameters
19
*BLK
Parameter write inhibit Used to select the reference and write ranges of the parameters. Operation can be performed for the parameters marked . Set value 0000 (Initial value) 000A 000B 000C 000E 100B 100C 100E Operation Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write No.19 only No.19 only Basic parameters No.0 to 19 Expansion parameters 1 No.20 to 49 Expansion parameters 2 No.50 to 84
0000
P S
5 - 10
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 20
Symbol *OP2
Name and function Function selection 2 Used to select restart after instantaneous power failure, servo lock at a stop in internal speed control mode, and slight vibration suppression control.
Unit
Control mode
Restart after instantaneous power failure If the power supply voltage has returned to normal after an undervoltage status caused by the reduction of the input power supply voltage in the speed control mode, the servo motor can be restarted by merely turning on the start signal without resetting the alarm. 0: Invalid (Undervoltage alarm (AL.10) occurs.) 1: Valid Stop-time servo lock selection The shaft can be servo-locked to remain still at a stop in the internal speed control mode. 0: Valid 1: Invalid Slight vibration suppression control Made valid when auto tuning selection is set to "0400" in parameter No.2. Used to suppress vibration at a stop. 0: Invalid 1: Valid Encoder cable communication system selection 0: Two-wire type 1: Four-wire type Incorrect setting will result in an encoder alarm 1 (AL.16) or encoder alarm 2 (AL.20).
Expansion parameters 1
P S
P S
21
*OP3
Function selection 3 (Command pulse selection) Used to select the input form of the pulse train input signal. (Refer to section 3.4.1.)
0000
0 0
Command pulse train input form 0: Forward/reverse rotation pulse train 1: Signed pulse train 2: A B-phase pulse train Pulse train logic selection 0: Positive logic 1: Negative logic
5 - 11
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 22
Symbol *OP4
Name and function Function selection 4 Used to select stop processing at forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) off and choose TLC/VLC output.
Unit
Setting range
Refer to
Control mode P S
0 0 0
How to make a stop when forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is valid. (Refer to section 5.2.3.) 0: Sudden stop 1: Slow stop
23
FFC
24 Expansion parameters 1
ZSP
Feed forward gain Set the feed forward gain. When the setting is 100 , the droop pulses during operation at constant speed are nearly zero. However, sudden acceleration/deceleration will increase the overshoot. As a guideline, when the feed forward gain setting is 100 , set 1s or more as the acceleration/deceleration time constant up to the rated speed. Zero speed Used to set the output range of the zero speed (ZSP). For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
0 to 100
50
r/min
0 to 10000
P S
25 26 27 *ENR
Encoder output pulses Used to set the encoder pulses (A-phase or B-phase) output by the servo amplifier. Set the value 4 times greater than the A-phase or B-phase pulses. You can use parameter No.54 to choose the output pulse designation or output division ratio setting. The number of A B-phase pulses actually output is 1/4 times greater than the preset number of pulses. The maximum output frequency is 1.3Mpps (after multiplication by 4). Use this parameter within this range. For output pulse designation Set "0 " (initial value) in parameter No.54. Set the number of pulses per servo motor revolution. Output pulse set value [pulses/rev] At the setting of 5600, for example, the actually A B-phase pulses output are as indicated below. 5600 A B-phase output pulses 1400[pulse] 4 For output division ratio setting Set "1 " in parameter No.54. The number of pulses per servo motor revolution is divided by the set value. Resolution per servo motor revolution Output pulse [pulses/rev] Set value At the setting of 8, for example, the actually A B-phase pulses output are as indicated below.
A B-phase output pulses 10000 8 1 4 313[pulse]
5 - 12
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 28
Symbol TL1
Name and function Internal torque limit 1 Set this parameter to limit servo motor torque on the assumption that the maximum torque is 100[ ]. When 0 is set, torque is not produced. (Note) External input Torque limit value made valid signals TL1 0 Internal torque limit value 1 (parameter No.28) 1 Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.28 Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.76 Note. 0: TL1-VIN off (open) 1: TL1-VIN on (short) When torque is output in analog monitor output, this set value is the maximum output voltage ( 8V). (Refer to section 3.4.1 (5)) For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Unit
Control mode P S
29 30 31 32 33
Expansion parameters 1
34
GD2
35
PG2
36
VG1
37
VG2
38
VIC
Analog monitor 1 offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog monitor 1 (MO1). Analog monitor 2 offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog monitor 2 (MO2). Electromagnetic brake sequence output Used to set the delay time (Tb) between electronic brake interlock (MBR) and the base drive circuit is shut-off. Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Used to set the ratio of the load inertia moment to the servo motor shaft inertia moment. When auto tuning mode 1 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. (Refer to section 7.1.1) In this case, it varies between 0 and 1000. Position loop gain 2 Used to set the gain of the position loop. Set this parameter to increase the position response to level load disturbance. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed loop gain 1 Normally this parameter setting need not be changed. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2, manual mode and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed loop gain 2 Set this parameter when vibration occurs on machines of low rigidity or large backlash. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed integral compensation Used to set the integral time constant of the speed loop. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed differential compensation Used to set the differential compensation. Made valid when the proportion control (PC) is switched on.
70
P S
35
rad/s
1 to 1000
177
rad/s
20 to 8000
P S
817
rad/s
20 to 20000
P S
48
ms
1 to 1000
P S
39
VDC
980
0 to 1000
P S
5 - 13
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 40 41
Symbol
Name and function For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Unit
Setting range
Control mode
*DIA
Input signal automatic ON selection Used to set automatic servo-on (SON) forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN).
0
Servo-on (SON) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring) Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring) Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring)
P S
P S
Expansion parameters 1
42
*DI1
Input signal selection 1 Used to assign the control mode changing signal input pins and to set the clear (CR).
0002
0 0
Control change (LOP) input pin assignment Used to set the control mode change signal input connector pins. Note that this parameter is made valid when parameter No.0 is set to select the position/internal speed change mode. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 Connector pin No. CN1-4 CN1-3 CN1-5 CN1-6 CN1-7
If forward rotation stroke end (LSP) or reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to any pin with parameter No.48, this setting is invalid. Clear (CR) selection 0: Droop pulses are cleared on the leading edge. 1: While turning on, droop pulses are always cleared.
5 - 14
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 43
Symbol *DI2
Name and function Input signal selection 2 (CN1-4) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 4. Note that the setting digit and assigned signal differ according to the control mode.
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0
Position control mode Internal speed control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 4 selected.
Signals that may be assigned in each control mode are indicated below by their symbols. Setting of any other signal will be invalid.
Set value 0 (Note) Control mode P SON RES PC CR S SON RES PC CR SP1 SP2 ST1 ST2 SP3 CM1 CM2 TL1 CDP TL1 CDP
Expansion parameters 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
Note. P: Position control mode S: Internal speed control mode This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 4. This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.48 is set to assign the Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) to be assigned to CN1-pin 4.
5 - 15
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 44
Symbol *DI3
Name and function Input signal selection 3 (CN1-3) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 3. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0
Position control mode Internal speed control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 3 selected.
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 3. This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.48 is set to assign the Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) to be assigned to CN1-pin 3. 45 *DI4 Input signal selection 4 (CN1-5) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 5. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43). 0995 Refer to name and function column. P S
Expansion parameters 1
0 9
Position control mode Internal speed control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 5 selected.
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 5. This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.48 is set to assign the Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) to be assigned to CN1-pin 5 46 *DI5 Input signal selection 5 (CN1-6) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 6. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43). 0000 Refer to name and function column. P S
0 0
Position control mode Internal speed control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 6 selected.
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 6. This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.48 is set to assign the Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) to be assigned to CN1-pin 6.
5 - 16
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 47
Symbol *DI6
Name and function Input signal selection 6 (CN1-7) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 7. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0
Position control mode Internal speed control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 7 selected.
48
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change signal (LOP) to CN1-pin 7. This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.48 is set to assign the Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) to be assigned to CN1-pin 7. *LSPN LSP/LSN input terminal selection Select the pins where the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) will be assigned. If the signals have already been assigned using parameter No.42 to 47, this parameter setting has preference. However, if the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) is assigned at pin 6 of CN1 (default setting), the setting of parameter No.46 takes priority. Similarly, if the reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned at pin 7 of CN1 (default setting), the setting of parameter No.47 takes priority. If the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) are assigned at the same pin, the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) takes priority while the reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is disabled.
0403
Expansion parameters 1
P S
0
Select the pin where the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) will be assigned. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 5 Connector pin No. CN1-5 CN1-4 CN1-6 CN1-7 CN1-3
Select the pin where the reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) will be assigned. The settings are the same as those of the first digit.
5 - 17
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 49
Symbol *DO1
Name and function Output signal selection 1 Used to select the connector pins to output the alarm code and warning (WNG).
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0
Setting of alarm code output
Set value 0 1
Connector pins
CN1-10 INP or SA CN1-11 RD CN1-12 ZSP
(Note) Alarm code Alarm CN1 CN1 CN1 display pin 10 pin 11 pin 12 88888 AL.12 AL.13 AL.15 0 0 0 AL.17 AL.19 AL.37 Watchdog
Name
Memory error 1 Clock error Memory error 2 Board error 2 Memory error 3 Parameter error
Serial communication time-out error
Expansion parameters 1
AL.8A AL.8E 0 1 1 0 0 0 AL.30 AL.33 AL.10 AL.45 1 1 0 AL.46 AL.50 AL.51 0 0 1 AL.24 AL.32 AL.31 0 1 1 AL.35 AL.52 AL.16 1 0 1 AL.1A AL.20
Serial communication error Regenerative error Overvoltage Undervoltage Main circuit device overheat Servo motor overheat Overload 1 Overload 2 Main circuit Overcurrent Overspeed Command pulse frequency error Error excessive Encoder error 1 Motor combination error Encoder error 2
Note. 0: Pin-VIN off (open) 1: Pin-VIN on (short) Setting of warning (WNG) output Select the connector pin to output warning. The old signal before selection will be unavailable. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 Connector pin No. Not output. CN1-11 CN1-9 CN1-10 CN1-12
5 - 18
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 50 51
Symbol
Name and function For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Unit
Setting range
Control mode
*OP6
Function selection 6 Used to select the operation to be performed when the reset (RES) switches on.
0 0
Operation to be performed when the reset (RES) switches on 0: Base circuit shut off 1: Base circuit not shut off
P S
52 53 *OP8
For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means. Function selection 8 Used to select the protocol of serial communication.
0
Protocol checksum selection 0: Yes (checksum added) 1: No (checksum not added)
Expansion parameters 2
54
*OP9
Function selection 9 Use to select the command pulse rotation direction, encoder output pulse direction and encoder pulse output setting.
0000
0
Servo motor rotation direction changing Changes the servo motor rotation direction for the input pulse train.
Set value 0 1 Servo motor rotation direction At forward rotation At reverse rotation pulse input pulse input CCW CW CW CCW
P S
Encoder pulse output phase changing Changes the phases of A B-phase encoder pulses output . Set value 0
A-phase B-phase A-phase B-phase Servo motor rotation direction
CCW
A-phase B-phase A-phase B-phase
CW
Encoder output pulse setting selection (refer to parameter No.27) 0: Output pulse setting 1: Division ratio setting
5 - 19
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 55
Symbol *OPA
Name and function Function selection A Used to select the position command acceleration/deceleration time constant (parameter No.7) control system.
Unit
Control mode P
0 0
0
Position command acceleration/deceleration time constant control 0: Primary delay 1: Linear acceleration/deceleration
56
SIC
Serial communication time-out selection Used to set the communication protocol time-out period in [s]. When you set "0", time-out check is not made. For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
0 s 10 0000
0 1 to 60
P S
57 58 NH1
Machine resonance suppression filter 1 Used to selection the machine resonance suppression filter. (Refer to section 8.2.)
0
Notch frequency selection Set "00" when you have set adaptive vibration suppression control to be "valid" or "held" (parameter No.60: 1 or 2 ).
Setting Setting Setting Setting Frequency Frequency Frequency Frequency value value value value
P S
Expansion parameters 2
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07
08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F
59
NH2
Machine resonance suppression filter 2 Used to set the machine resonance suppression filter.
0000
0
Notch frequency Same setting as in parameter No.58 However, you need not set "00" if you have set adaptive vibration suppression control to be "valid" or "held". Notch depth Same setting as in parameter No.58
P S
5 - 20
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 60
Symbol LPF
Name and function Low-pass filter/adaptive vibration suppression control Used to selection the low-pass filter and adaptive vibration suppression control. (Refer to chapter 8.)
Unit
Control mode P S
0
Low-pass filter selection 0: Valid (Automatic adjustment) 1: Invalid VG2 setting 10 When you choose "valid", 2 (1 GD2 setting 0.1) [Hz] bandwidth filter is set automatically. Adaptive vibration suppression control selection Choosing "valid" or "held" in adaptive vibration suppression control selection makes the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) invalid. 0: Invalid 1: Valid Machine resonance frequency is always detected and the filter is generated in response to resonance to suppress machine vibration. 2: Held The characteristics of the filter generated so far are held, and detection of machine resonance is stopped. Adaptive vibration suppression control sensitivity selection Used to set the sensitivity of machine resonance detection. 0: Normal 1: Large sensitivity
Expansion parameters 2
61
GD2B
Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 Used to set the ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment when gain changing is valid. Position control gain 2 changing ratio Used to set the ratio of changing the position control gain 2 when gain changing is valid. Made valid when auto tuning is invalid. Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Used to set the ratio of changing the speed control gain 2 when gain changing is valid. Made valid when auto tuning is invalid. Speed integral compensation changing ratio Used to set the ratio of changing the speed integral compensation when gain changing is valid. Made valid when auto tuning is invalid.
70
Multiplier
( 10 1)
P S
62
PG2B
100
63
VG2B
100
P S
64
VICB
100
P S
5 - 21
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 65
Symbol *CDP
Name and function Gain changing selection Used to select the gain changing condition. (Refer to section 8.5.)
Unit
Control mode P S
0 0 0
Gain changing selection Gains are changed in accordance with the settings of parameters No.61 to 64 under any of the following conditions: 0: Invalid 1: Gain changing (CDP) is ON 2: Command frequency is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting 3: Droop pulse value is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting 4: Servo motor speed is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting
Expansion parameters 2
66
CDS
Gain changing condition Used to set the value of gain changing condition (command frequency, droop pulses, servo motor speed) selected in parameter No.65.The set value unit changes with the changing condition item. (Refer to section 8.5.) Gain changing time constant Used to set the time constant at which the gains will change in response to the conditions set in parameters No.65 and 66. (Refer to section 8.5.) For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
10
10 to 9999 0 to 100
P S
67
CDT
P S
68 69 CMX2
Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 2 Used to set the multiplier for the command pulse. Setting "0" automatically sets the connected motor resolution. Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 3 Used to set the multiplier for the command pulse. Setting "0" automatically sets the connected motor resolution. Command pulse multiplying factor numerator 4 Used to set the multiplier for the command pulse. Setting "0" automatically sets the connected motor resolution. Internal speed command 4 Used to set speed 4 of internal speed commands.
70
CMX3
71
CMX4
72
SC4
200
5 - 22
5. PARAMETERS
Class
No. 73
Symbol SC5
Name and function Internal speed command 5 Used to set speed 5 of internal speed commands.
Unit r/min
74
SC6
500
r/min
75 Expansion parameters 2
SC7
800
r/min
Setting Control range mode 0 to S instantaneous permissible speed 0 to S instantaneous permissible speed 0 to S instantaneous permissible speed 0 to 100 P S
76
TL2
Internal torque limit 2 Set this parameter to limit servo motor torque on the assumption that the maximum torque is 100[ ]. When 0 is set, torque is not produced. When torque is output in analog monitor output, this set value is the maximum output voltage ( 8V). For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
100
77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84
5 - 23
5. PARAMETERS
CAUTION
POINT
1 CMX 50 . The guideline of the electronic gear setting range is 50 CDV If the set value is outside this range, noise may be generated during acceleration/ deceleration or operation may not be performed at the preset speed and/or acceleration/deceleration time constants. Always set the electronic gear with servo off state to prevent unexpected operation due to improper setting. The machine can be moved at any multiplication factor to input pulses.
Input pulse train Motor CMX CDV Deviation counter Feedback pulse
CMX CDV
Electronic gear
Encoder
The following setting examples are used to explain how to calculate the electronic gear. POINT The following specification symbols are required to calculate the electronic gear Pb : Ball screw lead [mm] n : Reduction ratio Pt : Servo motor resolution [pulses/rev] 0: Travel per command pulse [mm/pulse] S : Travel per servo motor revolution [mm/rev] : Angle per pulse [ /pulse] : Angle per revolution [ /rev] (1) For motion in increments of 10 m per pulse
n
Machine specifications Ball screw lead Pb 10 [mm] Reduction ratio: n 1/2 Servo motor resolution: Pt 10000 [pulses/rev]
CMX CDV
0
Pt S
Pt n Pb
10 10
10000 1/2 10
20000 1000
20 1
5 - 24
5. PARAMETERS
(2) Conveyor setting example For rotation in increments of 0.01 per pulse Machine specifications Table : 360 /rev Reduction ratio: n 1/18 Servo motor resolution: Pt
Servo motor 10000 [pulse/rev] Table
10000 [pulses/rev]
CMX CDV
Pt
0.01
100 20
5 1
Hence, set 5 to CMX and 1 to CDV. 5.2.2 Analog monitor The servo status can be output to two channels in terms of voltage. Using an ammeter enables monitoring the servo status. (1) Setting Change the following digits of parameter No.17.
Parameter No.17
0
Analog monitor 1 (MO1) output selection (Signal output to across MO1-LG) Analog monitor 2 (MO2) output selection (Signal output to across MO2-LG)
Parameters No.31 and 32 can be used to set the offset voltages to the analog output voltages. The setting range is between 999 and 999mV.
Parameter No. 31 32 Description Used to set the offset voltage for the analog monitor 1 (MO1) output. Used to set the offset voltage for the analog monitor 2 (MO2) output. Setting range [mV] 999 to 999
5 - 25
5. PARAMETERS
(2) Set content The servo amplifier is factory-set to output the servo motor speed to Analog monitor 1 (MO1) and the torque to Analog monitor 2 (MO2). The setting can be changed as listed below by changing the parameter No.17 value. Refer to app. 2 for the measurement point.
Setting 0 Output item Servo motor speed Description
8[V] CCW direction
Setting 6
Description
10[V] CCW direction
128[pulse] 0 128[pulse]
CW direction
8[V]
Driving in CCW direction
CW direction
10[V]
Torque (Note 2)
8[V]
10[V]
CCW direction
2048[pulse] 0 2048[pulse]
Driving in CW direction
8[V]
CW direction
10[V]
10[V]
CCW direction
8192[pulse] 0 8192[pulse]
Max. speed
Torque (Note 2)
Driving in CW direction 8[V] Driving in CCW direction
10[V]
32768[pulse] 0 32768[pulse]
Max. torque
0 Max. torque
CW direction 10[V]
Current command
8[V]
Max. command current
CCW direction
10[V]
CCW direction
131072[pulse] 0 131072[pulse]
CW direction
CW direction
10[V]
10[V]
CCW direction
Bus voltage
8[V]
500kpps 0 500kpps
0 400[V]
CW direction
10[V]
5 - 26
5. PARAMETERS
Command pulse frequency Droop pulse Speed command Speed control Current control PWM Current encoder
Current command
Bus voltage
M Servo motor
Note 1. Encoder pulse unit. 2. 8V is outputted at the maximum torque. However, when parameter No.28 76 are set to limit torque, 8V is outputted at the torque highly limited.
5 - 27
Differential Servo motor speed Torque
Current feedback
Encoder
Position feedback
5. PARAMETERS
5.2.3 Using forward/reverse rotation stroke end to change the stopping pattern The stopping pattern is factory-set to make a sudden stop when the forward/reverse rotation stroke end is made valid. A slow stop can be made by changing the parameter No.22 value.
Parameter No.22 setting 0 (initial value) Sudden stop Position control mode Internal speed control mode Slow stop Position control mode 1 Internal speed control mode Stopping method : Motor stops with droop pulses cleared. : Motor stops at deceleration time constant of zero. : The motor is decelerated to a stop in accordance with the parameter No.7 value. : The motor is decelerated to a stop in accordance with the parameter No.12 value.
5.2.4 Alarm history clear The servo amplifier stores one current alarm and five past alarms from when its power is switched on first. To control alarms which will occur during operation, clear the alarm history using parameter No.16 before starting operation. Clearing the alarm history automatically returns to " 0 ". After setting, this parameter is made valid by switch power from OFF to ON.
Parameter No.16
5 - 28
5. PARAMETERS
5.2.5 Position smoothing By setting the position command acceleration/deceleration time constant (parameter No.7), you can run the servo motor smoothly in response to a sudden position command. The following diagrams show the operation patterns of the servo motor in response to a position command when you have set the position command acceleration/deceleration time constant. Choose the primary delay or linear acceleration/deceleration in parameter No.55 according to the machine used. (1) For step input
: Input position command Command : Position command after filtering for primary delay : Position command after filtering for linear acceleration/deceleration : Position command acceleration/ deceleration time constant (parameter No.7)
t (3t) Time
: Position command after filtering for linear acceleration/deceleration : Position command after filtering for primary delay t : Position command acceleration/ deceleration time constant (parameter No.7)
t (3t) Time
5 - 29
5. PARAMETERS
MEMO
5 - 30
(Note) Cumulative feedback pulses [pulse] Servo motor speed [r/min] Droop pulses [pulse] Cumulative command pulses [pulse] Sequence Current alarm Parameter No.0 Parameter No.20 Parameter No.50
Last alarm
Parameter No.1
Parameter No.21
Parameter No.51
Output (DO) signal forced output Test operation mode Jog feed Test operation mode Positioning operation Test operation mode Motor-less operation
UP
DOWN
Parameter No.18 Parameter No.48 Parameter No.83
Parameter No.19
Parameter No.49
Parameter No.84
Regenerative load ratio [%] Effective load ratio [%] Peak load ratio [%]
Motor series ID
Motor type ID
Encoder ID
Note. The initial status display at power-on depends on the control mode. Position control mode: Cumulative feedback pulses(C), Internal speed control mode: Servo motor speed(r) Also, parameter No.18 can be used to change the initial indication of the status display at power-on.
6- 1
6.2 Status display The servo status during operation is shown on the 5-digit, 7-segment LED display. Press the "UP" or "DOWN" button to change display data as desired. When the required data is selected, the corresponding symbol appears. Press the "SET" button to display its data. At only power-on, however, data appears after the symbol of the status display selected in parameter No.18 has been shown for 2. The servo amplifier display shows the lower five digits of 16 data items such as the servo motor speed. 6.2.1 Display examples The following table lists display examples.
Item Status Displayed data Servo amplifier display
Forward rotation at 3000r/min Servo motor speed Reverse rotation at 3000r/min Reverse rotation is indicated by " ". Load inertia moment
15.5 times
11252pulse
Negative value is indicated by the lit decimal points in the upper four digits.
6- 2
6.2.2 Status display list The following table lists the servo statuses that may be shown.
Name Cumulative feedback pulses Symbol C Unit pulse Description Feedback pulses from the servo motor encoder are counted and displayed. The value in excess of 99999 is counted, bus since the servo amplifier display is five digits, it shows the lower five digits of the actual value. Press the "SET" button to reset the display value to zero. Reverse rotation is indicated by the lit decimal points in the upper four digits. The servo motor speed is displayed. The value rounded off is displayed in 0.1r/min. The number of droop pulses in the deviation counter is displayed. When the servo motor is rotating in the reverse direction, the decimal points in the upper four digits are lit. Since the servo amplifier display is five digits, it shows the lower five digits of the actual value. The number of pulses displayed is not yet multiplied by the electronic gear. The position command input pulses are counted and displayed. As the value displayed is not yet multiplied by the electronic gear (CMX/CDV), it may not match the indication of the cumulative feedback pulses. The value in excess of 99999 is counted, but since the servo amplifier display is five digits, it shows the lower five digits of the actual value. Press the "SET" button to reset the display value to zero. When the servo motor is rotating in the reverse direction, the decimal points in the upper four digits are lit. The frequency of the position command input pulses is displayed. The value displayed is not multiplied by the electronic gear (CMX/CDV). The ratio of regenerative power to permissible regenerative power is displayed in . The continuous effective load torque is displayed. The effective value in the past 15 seconds is displayed relative to the rated torque of 100 . The maximum torque generated during acceleration/deceleration, etc. The highest value in the past 15 seconds is displayed relative to the rated torque of 100 . Torque that occurred instantaneously is displayed. The value of the torque that occurred is displayed in real time relative to the rate torque of 100 . Position within one revolution is displayed in encoder pulses. The value returns to "0" when it exceeds the maximum number of pulses. The value is incremented in the CCW direction of rotation. Display range 99999 to 99999
r/min
Droop pulses
pulse
pulse
99999 to 99999
kpps
Instantaneous torque
Cy1
pulse
6- 3
Symbol Cy2
Description The within one-revolution position is displayed in 100 pulse increments of the encoder. The value returns to 0 when it exceeds the maximum number of pulses. The value is incremented in the CCW direction of rotation.
dC
Multiplier The estimated ratio of the load inertia moment to the servo motor shaft ( 1) inertia moment is displayed. V The voltage (across P-N) of the main circuit converter is displayed.
Pn
6.2.3 Changing the status display screen The status display item of the servo amplifier display shown at power-on can be changed by changing the parameter No.18 settings. The item displayed in the initial status changes with the control mode as follows.
Control mode Position Position/ internal speed Internal speed Status display at power-on Cumulative feedback pulses Cumulative feedback pulses/servo motor speed Servo motor speed
6- 4
Jog feed
Positioning operation
Screen for manufacturer setting. When this screen is being displayed, do not press any other buttons than "UP" and "DOWN" button.
Motor series ID
Press the "SET" button to show the motor series ID of the servo motor currently connected.
Motor type ID
Press the "SET" button to show the motor type ID of the servo motor currently connected.
Encoder ID
Press the "SET" button to show the encoder ID of the servo motor currently connected.
6- 5
6.4 Alarm mode The current alarm, past alarm history and parameter error are displayed. The lower 2 digits on the display indicate the alarm number that has occurred or the parameter number in error. Display examples are shown below.
Name Display Description Indicates no occurrence of an alarm. Current alarm Indicates the occurrence of overvoltage (AL.33). Flickers at occurrence of the alarm.
Indicates that the third alarm in the past is undervoltage (AL.10). Alarm history Indicates that the fourth alarm in the past is overspeed (AL.31).
Indicates no occurrence of parameter error (AL.37). Parameter error No. Indicates that the data of parameter No.1 is faulty.
Functions at occurrence of an alarm (1) Any mode screen displays the current alarm. (2) Even during alarm occurrence, the other screen can be viewed by pressing the button in the operation area. At this time, the decimal point in the fourth digit remains flickering. (3) For any alarm, remove its cause and clear it in any of the following methods (for clearable alarms, refer to section 10.2.1). (a) Switch power OFF, then ON. (b) Press the "SET" button on the current alarm screen. (c) Turn on the reset (RES). (4) Use parameter No.16 to clear the alarm history. (5) Pressing "SET" button on the alarm history display screen for 2s or longer shows the following detailed information display screen. Note that this is provided for maintenance by the manufacturer.
(6) Press the "UP" or "DOWN" button to display the next alarm in the history. 6- 6
6.5 Parameter mode The parameters whose abbreviations are marked* are made valid by changing the setting and then switching power off once and switching it on again. Refer to section 5.1.2. (1) Operation example The following example shows the operation procedure performed after power-on to change the control mode (parameter No.0) to the Internal speed control mode. Using the "MODE" button, show the basic parameter screen.
The parameter number is displayed. Press UP or DOWN to change the number.
Press SET twice. The set value of the specified parameter number flickers.
Press UP once. During flickering, the set value can be changed. Use ( or . UP DOWN 2: Internal speed control mode)
To shift to the next parameter, press the UP DOWN button. When changing the parameter No.0 setting, change its set value, then switch power off once and switch it on again to make the new value valid. (2) Expansion parameters To use the expansion parameters, change the setting of parameter No.19 (parameter write disable). Refer to section 5.1.1.
6- 7
6.6 External I/O signal display The ON/OFF states of the digital I/O signals connected to the servo amplifier can be confirmed. (1) Operation Call the display screen shown after power-on. Using the "MODE" button, show the diagnostic screen.
CN1 11
The 7-segment LED shown above indicates ON/OFF. Each segment at top indicates the input signal and each segment at bottom indicates the output signal. The signals corresponding to the pins in the respective control modes are indicated below.
CN1 Pin No. 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 21 Input/Output (Note 1) I/O I I I I I I O O O O O (Note 2) Signal abbreviation P RES SON CR LSP LSN EMG ALM INP RD ZSP OP S ST1 SON ST2 LSP LSN EMG ALM SA RD ZSP OP 49 49 49 49 Related parameter No. 43 to 47 43 to 47 43 to 47 43 to 48 43 to 48
Note 1. I: Input signal, O: Output signal 2. P: Position control mode, S: Internal speed control mode 3. CN1B-4 and CN1A-18 output signals are the same.
6- 8
Lit: ON Extinguished: OFF RD (CN 1-11) Ready INP (CN 1-10) In position ZSP (CN 1-12) Zero speed ALM (CN 1-9) Trouble OP (CN 1-21) Encoder Z-phase pulse
Lit: ON Extinguished: OFF RD (CN 1-11) Ready SA (CN 1-10) Limiting speed ZSP (CN 1-12) Zero speed ALM (CN 1-9) Trouble OP (CN 1-21) Encoder Z-phase pulse
6- 9
6.7 Output signal (DO) forced output POINT When the servo system is used in a vertical lift application, turning on the electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) after assigning it to pin CN1-12 will release the electromagnetic brake, causing a drop. Take drop preventive measures on the machine side. The output signal can be forced on/off independently of the servo status. This function is used for output signal wiring check, etc. This operation must be performed in the servo off state. Operation Call the display screen shown after power-on. Using the "MODE" button, show the diagnostic screen.
Press UP twice.
Press SET for more than 2 seconds. Switch on/off the signal below the lit segment. Always lit Indicates the ON/OFF of the output signal. The correspondences between segments and signals are as in the output signals of the external I/O signal display. (Lit: ON, extinguished: OFF) Press MODE once. The segment above CN1-pin 10 is lit.
CN1 12
CN1 9
CN1 12
CN1 10
CN1 11
Press UP once. CN1-pin 10 is switched on. (CN1-pin 10-VIN conduct.) Press DOWN once. CN1-pin 10 is switched off.
6 - 10
6.8 Test operation mode The test operation mode is designed to confirm servo operation and not to confirm machine operation. In this mode, do not use the servo motor with the machine. Always use the servo motor alone. If any operational fault has occurred, stop operation using the emergency stop (EMG) signal. POINT The MR Configurator (servo configuration software) is required to perform positioning operation. Test operation cannot be performed if the servo-on (SON) is not turned OFF. 6.8.1 Mode change Call the display screen shown after power-on. Choose jog operation/motor-less operation in the following procedure. Using the "MODE" button, show the diagnostic screen.
CAUTION
Press SET for more than 2s. When this screen appears, jog feed can be performed. Flickers in the test operation mode.
Press SET for more than 2s. When this screen is displayed, motor-less operation can be performed.
6 - 11
6.8.2 Jog operation Jog operation can be performed when there is no command from the external command device. (1) Operation Connect EMG-VIN to start jog operation to use the internal power supply. Hold down the "UP" or "DOWN" button to run the servo motor. Release it to stop. When using the MR Configurator (servo configuration software), you can change the operation conditions. The initial conditions and setting ranges for operation are listed below.
Item Speed [r/min] Acceleration/deceleration time constant [ms] Initial setting 200 1000 Setting range 0 to instantaneous permissible speed 0 to 50000
If the communication cable is disconnected during jog operation performed by using the MR Configurator (servo configuration software), the servo motor will be decelerated to a stop. (2) Status display You can confirm the servo status during jog operation. Pressing the "MODE" button in the jog operation-ready status calls the status display screen. With this screen being shown, perform jog operation with the "UP" or "DOWN" button. Every time you press the "MODE" button, the next status display screen appears, and on completion of a screen cycle, pressing that button returns to the jog operation-ready status screen. For full information of the status display, refer to section 6.2. In the test operation mode, you cannot use the "UP" and "DOWN" buttons to change the status display screen from one to another. (3) Termination of jog operation To end the jog operation, switch power off once or press the "MODE" button to switch to the next screen and then hold down the "SET" button for 2 or more seconds.
6 - 12
6.8.3 Positioning operation POINT The MR Configurator (servo configuration software) is required to perform positioning operation. Positioning operation can be performed once when there is no command from the external command device. (1) Operation Connect EMG-VIN to start positioning operation to use the internal power supply. Click the "Forward" or "Reverse" button on the MR Configurator (servo configuration software) starts the servo motor, which will then stop after moving the preset travel distance. You can change the operation conditions on the MR Configurator (servo configuration software). The initial conditions and setting ranges for operation are listed below.
Item Travel distance [pulse] Speed [r/min] Acceleration/deceleration time constant [ms] Initial setting 10000 200 1000 Setting range 0 to 9999999 0 to instantaneous permissible speed 0 to 50000
If the communication cable is disconnected during positioning operation, the servo motor will come to a sudden stop. (2) Status display You can monitor the status display even during positioning operation.
6 - 13
6.8.4 Motor-less operation Without connecting the servo motor, you can provide output signals or monitor the status display as if the servo motor is running in response to external input signals. This operation can be used to check the sequence of a host programmable controller or the like. (1) Operation After turning off the signal across SON-VIN, choose motor-less operation. After that, perform external operation as in ordinary operation. (2) Status display You can confirm the servo status during motor-less operation. Pressing the "MODE" button in the motor-less operation-ready status calls the status display screen. With this screen being shown, perform motor-less operation. Every time you press the "MODE" button, the next status display screen appears, and on completion of a screen cycle, pressing that button returns to the motor-less operation-ready status screen. For full information of the status display, refer to section 6.2. In the test operation mode, you cannot use the "UP" and "DOWN" buttons to change the status display screen from one to another. (3) Termination of motor-less operation To terminate the motor-less operation, switch power off.
6 - 14
020
Fixed to parameter No.34 PG1 (parameter No.6) PG2 (parameter No.35) value VG1 (parameter No.36) VG2 (parameter No.37) VIC (parameter No.38) PG2 (parameter No.35) VG1 (parameter No.36)
Manual mode 1
030
PG1 (parameter No.6) GD2 (parameter No.34) VG2 (parameter No.37) VIC (parameter No.38) PG1 (parameter No.6) GD2 (parameter No.34) PG2 (parameter No.35) VG1 (parameter No.36) VG2 (parameter No.37) VIC (parameter No.38)
Manual mode 2
040
Interpolation mode
000
Always estimated
GD2 (parameter No.34) PG2 (parameter No.35) VG2 (parameter No.37) VIC (parameter No.38)
7- 1
Usage
Interpolation made for 2 or more axes?
No
Used when you want to match the position gain (PG1) between 2 or more axes. Normally not used for other purposes. Allows adjustment by merely changing the response level setting. First use this mode to make adjustment.
OK? Yes
Used when the conditions of auto tuning mode 1 are not met and the load inertia moment ratio could not be estimated properly, for example.
Yes
This mode permits adjustment easily with three gains if you were not satisfied with auto tuning results.
Yes
You can adjust all gains manually when you want to do fast settling or the like.
7.1.2 Adjustment using MR Configurator (servo configuration software) This section gives the functions and adjustment that may be performed by using the servo amplifier with the MR Configurator (servo configuration software) which operates on a personal computer.
Function Machine analyzer Description With the machine and servo motor coupled, the characteristic of the mechanical system can be measured by giving a random vibration command from the personal computer to the servo and measuring the machine response. Executing gain search under to-and-fro positioning command measures settling characteristic while simultaneously changing gains, and automatically searches for gains which make settling time shortest. Response at positioning settling of a machine can be simulated from machine analyzer results on personal computer. Adjustment You can grasp the machine resonance frequency and determine the notch frequency of the machine resonance suppression filter. You can automatically set the optimum gains in response to the machine characteristic. This simple adjustment is suitable for a machine which has large machine resonance and does not require much settling time. You can automatically set gains which make positioning settling time shortest.
Gain search
Machine simulation
You can optimize gain adjustment and command pattern on personal computer.
7- 2
7.2 Auto tuning 7.2.1 Auto tuning mode The servo amplifier has a real-time auto tuning function which estimates the machine characteristic (load inertia moment ratio) in real time and automatically sets the optimum gains according to that value. This function permits ease of gain adjustment of the servo amplifier. (1) Auto tuning mode 1 The servo amplifier is factory-set to the auto tuning mode 1. In this mode, the load inertia moment ratio of a machine is always estimated to set the optimum gains automatically. The following parameters are automatically adjusted in the auto tuning mode 1.
Parameter No. 6 34 35 36 37 38 Abbreviation PG1 GD2 PG2 VG1 VG2 VIC Position control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 1 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Name
POINT The auto tuning mode 1 may not be performed properly if the following conditions are not satisfied. Time to reach 2000r/min is the acceleration/deceleration time constant of 5s or less. Speed is 150r/min or higher. The ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment is not more than 100 times. The acceleration/deceleration torque is 10 or more of the rated torque. Under operating conditions which will impose sudden disturbance torque during acceleration/deceleration or on a machine which is extremely loose, auto tuning may not function properly, either. In such cases, use the auto tuning mode 2 or manual mode 1,2 to make gain adjustment. (2) Auto tuning mode 2 Use the auto tuning mode 2 when proper gain adjustment cannot be made by auto tuning mode 1. Since the load inertia moment ratio is not estimated in this mode, set the value of a correct load inertia moment ratio (parameter No.34). The following parameters are automatically adjusted in the auto tuning mode 2.
Parameter No. 6 35 36 37 38 Abbreviation PG1 PG2 VG1 VG2 VIC Position control gain 1 Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 1 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Name
7- 3
7.2.2 Auto tuning mode operation The block diagram of real-time auto tuning is shown below.
Automatic setting Command Control gains PG1,VG1 PG2,VG2,VIC Current control Current feedback Set 0 or 1 to turn on. Real-time auto tuning section Load inertia moment ratio estimation section Position/speed feedback Load inertia moment Servo motor Encoder
Gain table
Switch
Speed feedback
Parameter No. 2
Parameter No. 34 Load inertia moment ratio estimation value First digit Response level setting
When a servo motor is accelerated/decelerated, the load inertia moment ratio estimation section always estimates the load inertia moment ratio from the current and speed of the servo motor. The results of estimation are written to parameter No.34 (the ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor). These results can be confirmed on the status display screen of the MR Configurator (servo configuration software) section. If the value of the load inertia moment ratio is already known or if estimation cannot be made properly, chose the "auto tuning mode 2" (parameter No.2: 2 ) to stop the estimation of the load inertia moment ratio (Switch in above diagram turned off), and set the load inertia moment ratio (parameter No.34) manually. From the preset load inertia moment ratio (parameter No.34) value and response level (The first digit of parameter No.2), the optimum control gains are automatically set on the basis of the internal gain tale. The auto tuning results are saved in the EEP-ROM of the servo amplifier every 60 minutes since power-on. At power-on, auto tuning is performed with the value of each control gain saved in the EEP-ROM being used as an initial value. POINT If sudden disturbance torque is imposed during operation, the estimation of the inertia moment ratio may malfunction temporarily. In such a case, choose the "auto tuning mode 2" (parameter No.2: 2 ) and set the correct load inertia moment ratio in parameter No.34. When any of the auto tuning mode 1, auto tuning mode 2 and manual mode 1 settings is changed to the manual mode 2 setting, the current control gains and load inertia moment ratio estimation value are saved in the EEP-ROM.
7- 4
7.2.3 Adjustment procedure by auto tuning Since auto tuning is made valid before shipment from the factory, simply running the servo motor automatically sets the optimum gains that match the machine. Merely changing the response level setting value as required completes the adjustment. The adjustment procedure is as follows.
Acceleration/deceleration repeated
Yes
Load inertia moment ratio estimation value stable? No Auto tuning conditions not satisfied. (Estimation of load inertia moment ratio is difficult)
No
Yes Choose the auto tuning mode 2 (parameter No.2: 020 ) and set the load inertia moment ratio (parameter No.34) manually.
Adjust response level setting so that desired response is achieved on vibration-free level.
Acceleration/deceleration repeated
No
To manual mode
7- 5
7.2.4 Response level setting in auto tuning mode Set the response (The first digit of parameter No.2) of the whole servo system. As the response level setting is increased, the track ability and settling time for a command decreases, but a too high response level will generate vibration. Hence, make setting until desired response is obtained within the vibration-free range. If the response level setting cannot be increased up to the desired response because of machine resonance beyond 100Hz, adaptive vibration suppression control (parameter No.60) or machine resonance suppression filter (parameter No.58 59) may be used to suppress machine resonance. Suppressing machine resonance may allow the response level setting to increase. Refer to section 8.2, 8.3 for adaptive vibration suppression control and machine resonance suppression filter.
Parameter No.2
Machine characteristic Response level setting 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F High Middle Machine rigidity Low Machine resonance frequency guideline 15Hz 20Hz 25Hz 30Hz 35Hz 45Hz 55Hz 70Hz 85Hz 105Hz 130Hz 160Hz 200Hz 240Hz 300Hz
Precision working machine Inserter Mounter Bonder General machine tool conveyor Arm robot Large conveyor
7- 6
7.3 Manual mode 1 (simple manual adjustment) If you are not satisfied with the adjustment of auto tuning, you can make simple manual adjustment with three parameters. 7.3.1 Operation of manual mode 1 In this mode, setting the three gains of position control gain 1 (PG1), speed control gain 2 (VG2) and speed integral compensation (VIC) automatically sets the other gains to the optimum values according to these gains.
User setting PG1 VG2 VIC GD2
Automatic setting
PG2 VG1
Therefore, you can adjust the model adaptive control system in the same image as the general PI control system (position gain, speed gain, speed integral time constant). Here, the position gain corresponds to PG1, the speed gain to VG2 and the speed integral time constant to VIC. When making gain adjustment in this mode, set the load inertia moment ratio (parameter No.34) correctly. 7.3.2 Adjustment by manual mode 1 POINT If machine resonance occurs, adaptive vibration suppression control (parameter No.60) or machine resonance suppression filter (parameter No.58 59) may be used to suppress machine resonance. (Refer to section 8.2, 8.3.) (1) For speed control (a) Parameters The following parameters are used for gain adjustment.
Parameter No. 34 37 38 Abbreviation GD2 VG2 VIC Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Name Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment
Increase the speed control gain. Decrease the time constant of the speed integral compensation. Suppression of machine resonance. Refer to section 8.2, 8.3.
Fine adjustment
7- 7
(c)Adjustment description 1) Speed control gain 2 (parameter No.37) This parameter determines the response level of the speed control loop. Increasing this value enhances response but a too high value will make the mechanical system liable to vibrate. The actual response frequency of the speed loop is as indicated in the following expression.
(1
Speed control gain 2 setting ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment) 2
2) Speed integral compensation (VIC: parameter No.38) To eliminate stationary deviation against a command, the speed control loop is under proportional integral control. For the speed integral compensation, set the time constant of this integral control. Increasing the setting lowers the response level. However, if the load inertia moment ratio is large or the mechanical system has any vibratory element, the mechanical system is liable to vibrate unless the setting is increased to some degree. The guideline is as indicated in the following expression.
2000 to 3000 Speed control gain 2 setting/(1 ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment setting
0.1)
(2) For position control (a) Parameters The following parameters are used for gain adjustment.
Parameter No. 6 34 37 38 Abbreviation PG1 GD2 VG2 VIC Position control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Name
Fine adjustment
7- 8
(c) Adjustment description 1) Position control gain 1 (parameter No.6) This parameter determines the response level of the position control loop. Increasing position control gain 1 improves track ability to a position command but a too high value will make overshooting liable to occur at the time of settling.
(1
Speed control gain 2 setting ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment)
1 1 to 3 5
2) Speed control gain 2 (VG2: parameter No.37) This parameter determines the response level of the speed control loop. Increasing this value enhances response but a too high value will make the mechanical system liable to vibrate. The actual response frequency of the speed loop is as indicated in the following expression. Speed loop response frequency(Hz) (1 Speed control gain 2 setting ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment) 2
3) Speed integral compensation (parameter No.38) To eliminate stationary deviation against a command, the speed control loop is under proportional integral control. For the speed integral compensation, set the time constant of this integral control. Increasing the setting lowers the response level. However, if the load inertia moment ratio is large or the mechanical system has any vibratory element, the mechanical system is liable to vibrate unless the setting is increased to some degree. The guideline is as indicated in the following expression.
2000 to 3000 Speed control gain 2 setting/(1 ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 setting
0.1)
7- 9
7.4 Interpolation mode The interpolation mode is used to match the position control gains of the axes when performing the interpolation operation of servo motors of two or more axes for an X-Y table or the like. In this mode, the position control gain 2 and speed control gain 2 which determine command track ability are set manually and the other parameter for gain adjustment are set automatically. (1) Parameter (a) Automatically adjusted parameters The following parameters are automatically adjusted by auto tuning.
Parameter No. 34 35 37 38 Abbreviation GD2 PG2 VG2 VIC Name Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation
(b) Manually adjusted parameters The following parameters are adjustable manually.
Parameter No. 6 36 Abbreviation PG1 VG1 Position control gain 1 Speed control gain 1 Name
Fine adjustment.
(3) Adjustment description (a) Position control gain 1 (parameter No.6) This parameter determines the response level of the position control loop. Increasing position control gain 1 improves track ability to a position command but a too high value will make overshooting liable to occur at the time of settling. The droop pulse value is determined by the following expression. Rotation speed (r/min) 131,072(pulse) 60 Droop pulse value (pulse) Position control gain 1 setting
(b) Speed control gain 1 (parameter No.36) Set the response level of the speed loop of the model. Make setting using the following expression as a guideline. Position control gain 1 setting 3 Speed control gain 1 setting 7 - 10
Parameter No.58
Parameter No.60
0
00
except
00
Encoder
except
00
or
8.2 Machine resonance suppression filter (1) Function The machine resonance suppression filter is a filter function (notch filter) which decreases the gain of the specific frequency to suppress the resonance of the mechanical system. You can set the gain decreasing frequency (notch frequency) and gain decreasing depth.
Mechanical system response level Machine resonance point
Frequency
8- 1
You can use the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) and machine resonance suppression filter 2 (parameter No.59) to suppress the vibration of two resonance frequencies. Note that if adaptive vibration suppression control is made valid, the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) is made invalid.
Machine resonance point Mechanical system response level
Frequency
POINT The machine resonance suppression filter is a delay factor for the servo system. Hence, vibration may increase if you set a wrong resonance frequency or a too deep notch. (2) Parameters (a) Machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) Set the notch frequency and notch depth of the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) When you have made adaptive vibration suppression control selection (parameter No.60) "valid" or "held", make the machine resonance suppression filter 1 invalid (parameter No.58: 0000).
Parameter No.58
Notch frequency
Setting Setting Setting Setting Frequency Frequency Frequency Frequency value value value value
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07
08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F
Notch depth
Setting value Depth (Gain)
00 00 00 00
Deep ( ( ( Shallow(
8- 2
POINT If the frequency of machine resonance is unknown, decrease the notch frequency from higher to lower ones in order. The optimum notch frequency is set at the point where vibration is minimal. A deeper notch has a higher effect on machine resonance suppression but increases a phase delay and may increase vibration. The machine characteristic can be grasped beforehand by the machine analyzer on the MR Configurator (servo configuration software). This allows the required notch frequency and depth to be determined. Resonance may occur if parameter No.58 59 is used to select a close notch frequency and set a deep notch. (b) Machine resonance suppression filter 2 (parameter No.59) The setting method of machine resonance suppression filter 2 (parameter No.59) is the same as that of machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58). However, the machine resonance suppression filter 2 can be set independently of whether adaptive vibration suppression control is valid or invalid. 8.3 Adaptive vibration suppression control (1) Function Adaptive vibration suppression control is a function in which the servo amplifier detects machine resonance and sets the filter characteristics automatically to suppress mechanical system vibration. Since the filter characteristics (frequency, depth) are set automatically, you need not be conscious of the resonance frequency of a mechanical system. Also, while adaptive vibration suppression control is valid, the servo amplifier always detects machine resonance, and if the resonance frequency changes, it changes the filter characteristics in response to that frequency.
Mechanical system response level Machine resonance point Mechanical system response Frequency level Machine resonance point
Frequency
POINT The machine resonance frequency which adaptive vibration suppression control can respond to is about 150 to 500Hz. Adaptive vibration suppression control has no effect on the resonance frequency outside this range. Use the machine resonance suppression filter for the machine resonance of such frequency. Adaptive vibration suppression control may provide no effect on a mechanical system which has complex resonance characteristics or which has too large resonance. Under operating conditions in which sudden disturbance torque is imposed during operation, the detection of the resonance frequency may malfunction temporarily, causing machine vibration. In such a case, set adaptive vibration suppression control to be "held" (parameter No.60: 2 ) to fix the characteristics of the adaptive vibration suppression control filter. 8- 3
(2) Parameters The operation of adaptive vibration suppression control selection (parameter No.60).
Parameter No.60
Adaptive vibration suppression control selection Choosing "valid" or "held" in adaptive vibration suppression control selection makes the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) invalid. 0: Invalid 1: Valid Machine resonance frequency is always detected to generate the filter in response to resonance, suppressing machine vibration. 2: Held Filter characteristics generated so far is held, and detection of machine resonance is stopped. Adaptive vibration suppression control sensitivity selection Set the sensitivity of detecting machine resonance. 0: Normal 1: Large sensitivity
POINT Adaptive vibration suppression control is factory-set to be invalid (parameter No.60: 0000). Setting the adaptive vibration suppression control sensitivity can change the sensitivity of detecting machine resonance. Setting of "large sensitivity" detects smaller machine resonance and generates a filter to suppress machine vibration. However, since a phase delay will also increase, the response of the servo system may not increase. 8.4 Low-pass filter (1) Function When a ball screw or the like is used, resonance of high frequency may occur as the response level of the servo system is increased. To prevent this, the low-pass filter is factory-set to be valid for a torque command. The filter frequency of this low-pass filter is automatically adjusted to the value in the following expression. Speed control gain 2 setting 10 Filter frequency(Hz) (1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment setting 0.1) 2
(2) Parameter Set the operation of the low-pass filter (parameter No.60.)
Parameter No.60
initial value
POINT In a mechanical system where rigidity is extremely high and resonance level is difficult to occur, setting the low-pass filter to be "invalid" may increase the servo system response level to shorten the settling time.
8- 4
GD2 Parameter No.34 GD2B Parameter No.61 PG2 Parameter No.35 PG2 PG2B 100
8- 5
8.5.3 Parameters 4 " in parameter No.2 (auto tuning) to choose the When using the gain changing function, always set " manual mode of the gain adjustment modes. The gain changing function cannot be used in the auto tuning mode.
Parameter No. 6 36 34 35 37 38 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 Abbrevi ation PG1 VG1 GD2 PG2 VG2 VIC GD2B PG2B VG2B VICB CDP CDS CDT Name Position control gain 1 Speed control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 Position control gain 2 changing ratio Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Speed integral compensation changing ratio Gain changing selection Gain changing condition Gain changing time constant kpps pulse r/min ms Unit rad/s rad/s Description Position and speed gains of a model used to set the response level to a command. Always valid.
Multiplier Control parameters before changing. ( 10 1) rad/s rad/s ms Multiplier Used to set the ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia ( 10 1) moment after changing. Used to set the ratio ( ) of the after-changing position control gain 2 to position control gain 2. Used to set the ratio ( ) of the after-changing speed control gain 2 to speed control gain 2. Used to set the ratio ( ) of the after-changing speed integral compensation to speed integral compensation. Used to select the changing condition. Used to set the changing condition values.
You can set the filter time constant for a gain change at changing.
8- 6
(1) Parameters No.6, 34 to 38 These parameters are the same as in ordinary manual adjustment. Gain changing allows the values of ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment, position control gain 2, speed control gain 2 and speed integral compensation to be changed. (2) Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 (GD2B: parameter No.61) Set the ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment after changing. If the load inertia moment ratio does not change, set it to the same value as ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment (parameter No.34). (3) Position control gain 2 changing ratio (parameter No.62), speed control gain 2 changing ratio (parameter No.63), speed integral compensation changing ratio (parameter No.64) Set the values of after-changing position control gain 2, speed control gain 2 and speed integral compensation in ratio ( ). 100 setting means no gain change. For example, at the setting of position control gain 2 100, speed control gain 2 2000, speed integral compensation 20 and position control gain 2 changing ratio 180 , speed control gain 2 changing ratio 150 and speed integral compensation changing ratio 80 , the after-changing values are as follows. Position control gain 2 changing ratio /100 180rad/s Position control gain 2 Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 changing ratio /100 3000rad/s Speed integral compensation Speed integral compensation Speed integral compensation changing ratio /100 16ms (4) Gain changing selection (parameter No.65) Used to set the gain changing condition. Choose the changing condition in the first digit. If you set "1" here, you can use the gain changing (CDP) external input signal for gain changing. The gain changing (CDP) can be assigned to the pins using parameters No.43 to 48.
Parameter No.65
Gain changing selection Gains are changed in accordance with the settings of parameters No.61 to 64 under any of the following conditions: 0: Invalid 1: Gain changing (CDP) input is ON 2: Command frequency is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting 3: Droop pulse value is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting 4: Servo motor speed is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting
(5) Gain changing condition (parameter No.66) When you selected "command frequency", "droop pulses" or "servo motor speed" in gain changing selection (parameter No.65), set the gain changing level. The setting unit is as follows.
Gain changing condition Command frequency Droop pulses Servo motor speed Unit kpps pulse r/min
(6) Gain changing time constant (parameter No.67) You can set the primary delay filter to each gain at gain changing. This parameter is used to suppress shock given to the machine if the gain difference is large at gain changing, for example. 8- 7
8.5.4 Gain changing operation This operation will be described by way of setting examples. (1) When you choose changing by external input (a) Setting
Parameter No. 6 36 34 35 37 38 61 62 63 64 Abbreviation PG1 VG1 GD2 PG2 VG2 VIC GD2B PG2B VG2B VICB Name Position control gain 1 Speed control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 Position control gain 2 changing ratio Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Speed integral compensation changing ratio Gain changing selection Gain changing time constant Setting 100 1000 4 120 3000 20 100 70 133 250 0001 (Changed by ON/OFF of pin CN1-10) 100 ms Unit rad/s rad/s Multiplier ( 10 1) rad/s rad/s ms Multiplier ( 10 1)
65 67
CDP CDT
Position control gain 1 Speed control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation 4.0 120 3000 20
8- 8
CDS CDS
After-changing gain
Position control gain 1 Speed control gain 1 Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position control gain 2 Speed control gain 2 Speed integral compensation 4.0 120 3000 20 10.0 84 4000 50
8- 9
MEMO
8 - 10
9. INSPECTION
9. INSPECTION
Before starting maintenance and/or inspection, turn off the power and wait for 15 minutes or more until the charge lamp turns off. Otherwise, an electric shock may occur. In addition, always confirm from the front of the servo amplifier whether the charge lamp is off or not. Any person who is involved in inspection should be fully competent to do the work. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock. For repair and parts replacement, contact your safes representative. POINT Do not test the servo amplifier with a megger (measure insulation resistance), or it may become faulty. Do not disassemble and/or repair the equipment on customer side. (1) Inspection It is recommended to make the following checks periodically. (a) Check for loose terminal block screws. Retighten any loose screws. (b) Check the cables and the like for scratches and cracks. Perform periodic inspection according to operating conditions. (c) Check the servo motor bearings, brake section, etc. for unusual noise. (d) Check the cables and the like for scratches and cracks. Perform periodic inspection according to operating conditions. (e) Check the servo motor shaft and coupling for misalignment. (2) Life The following parts must be changed periodically as listed below. If any part is found faulty, it must be changed immediately even when it has not yet reached the end of its life, which depends on the operating method and environmental conditions. For parts replacement, please contact your sales representative.
Part name Smoothing capacitor Relay Bearings Encoder Oil seal 10 years Number of power-on and number of emergency stop times: 100,000 times 20,000 to 30,000 hours 20,000 to 30,000 hours 5,000 hours Life guideline
WARNING
(a) Smoothing capacitor Affected by ripple currents, etc. and deteriorates in characteristic. The life of the capacitor greatly depends on ambient temperature and operating conditions. The capacitor will reach the end of its life in 10 years of continuous operation in normal air-conditioned environment. (b) Relays Their contacts will wear due to switching currents and contact faults occur. Relays reach the end of their life when the cumulative number of power-on and emergency stop times is 100,000, which depends on the power supply capacity.
9- 1
9. INSPECTION
(c) Servo amplifier cooling fan The cooling fan bearings reach the end of their life in 10,000 to 30,000 hours. Normally, therefore, the cooling fan must be changed in a few years of continuous operation as a guideline. It must also be changed if unusual noise or vibration is found during inspection. (d) Bearings When the servo motor is run at rated speed under rated load, change the bearings in 20,000 to 30,000 hours as a guideline. This differs on the operating conditions. The bearings must also be changed if unusual noise or vibration is found during inspection. (e) Oil seal, V ring Must be changed in 5,000 hours of operation at rated speed as a guideline. This differs on the operating conditions. These parts must also be changed if oil leakage, etc. is found during inspection.
9- 2
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
10.1 Trouble at start-up
CAUTION
Excessive adjustment or change of parameter setting must not be made as it will make operation instable. POINT Using the optional MR Configurator (servo configuration software), you can refer to unrotated servo motor reasons, etc.
The following faults may occur at start-up. If any of such faults occurs, take the corresponding action. 10.1.1 Position control mode (1) Troubleshooting
No. 1 Start-up sequence Power on (Note) Fault LED is not lit. LED flickers. Investigation Not improved if connectors CN1, CN2 and CN3 are disconnected. Improved when connectors CN1 is disconnected. Improved when connector CN2 is disconnected. Improved when connector CN3 is disconnected. Alarm occurs. 2 Switch on servo-on signal. Alarm occurs. Servo motor shaft is not servo-locked (is free). Possible cause 1. Power supply voltage fault 2. Servo amplifier is faulty. Power supply of CNP1 cabling is shorted. 1. Power supply of encoder cabling is shorted. 2. Encoder is faulty. Power supply of CN3 cabling is shorted. Section 10.2 Section 10.2 Section 6.6 Reference
Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. 1. Check the display to see if the servo amplifier is ready to operate. 2. Check the external I/O signal indication to see if the servo-on (SON) signal is ON. 1. Servo-on signal is not input. (Wiring mistake) 2. 24VDC power is not supplied to COM.
1. Wiring mistake (a) For open collector pulse train input, 24VDC power is not supplied to OPC. (b) LSP/LSN-VIN are not connected. 2. No pulses is input. 1. Mistake in wiring to controller. 2. Mistake in setting of parameter No.54.
Section 6.2
Chapter 5
10 - 1
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
No. 4
Investigation Make gain adjustment in the following procedure. 1. Increase the auto tuning response level. 2. Repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning.
Reference Chapter 7
Large load inertia moment causes the servo motor shaft to oscillate side to side. 5 Cyclic operation Position shift occurs.
If the servo motor may be run Gain adjustment fault with safety, repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning.
Chapter 7
Pulse counting error, etc. Confirm the cumulative due to noise. command pulses, cumulative feedback pulses and actual servo motor position. Note. Switch power on again after making sure that the charge lamp has turned off completely.
10 - 2
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Servo amplifier Electronic gear (parameters No.3, 4) Servo motor P CMX CDV M Machine L (d) Machine stop position M (B)
Q (A) (C) Servo-on (SON), forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) input
When a position shift occurs, check (a) output pulse counter, (b) cumulative command pulse display, (c) cumulative feedback pulse display, and (d) machine stop position in the above diagram. (A), (B) and (C) indicate position shift causes. For example, (A) indicates that noise entered the wiring between positioning unit and servo amplifier, causing pulses to be miss-counted. In a normal status without position shift, there are the following relationships. 1) Q P (positioning unit's output counter servo amplifier's cumulative command pulses) CMX(parameter No.3) 2) P CDV(parameter No.4) C (cumulative command pulses electronic gear cumulative feedback pulses) 3) C M (cumulative feedback pulses travel per pulse machine position)
Check for a position shift in the following sequence. 1) When Q P Noise entered the pulse train signal wiring between positioning unit and servo amplifier, causing pulses to be miss-counted. (Cause A) Make the following check or take the following measures. Check how the shielding is done. Change the open collector system to the differential line driver system. Run wiring away from the power circuit. Install a data line filter. CMX C 2) When P CDV During operation, the servo-on signal (SON) or forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) signal was switched off or the clear signal (CR) and the reset signal (RES) switched on. (Cause C) If a malfunction may occur due to much noise, increase the input filter setting (parameter No.1). M 3) When C Mechanical slip occurred between the servo motor and machine. (Cause B)
10 - 3
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. 1. Servo-on signal is not input. 1. Check the display to see if (Wiring mistake) the servo amplifier is ready 2. 24VDC power is not supplied to operate. to COM. 2. Check the external I/O signal indication to see if the servo-on (SON) signal is ON.
Servo motor does not Call the external I/O signal LSP, LSN, ST1 or ST2 is off. rotate. display and check the ON/OFF status of the input signal. Set value is 0. Check the internal speed commands 1 to 7 (parameters No.8 to 10 72 to 75). Check the internal torque limit 1 (parameter No.28). Torque limit level is too low as compared to the load torque. Gain adjustment fault
Section 6.6
Gain adjustment
Make gain adjustment in the following procedure. 1. Increase the auto tuning response level. 2. Repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning.
Chapter 7
If the servo motor may be run Gain adjustment fault with safety, repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning. Note. Switch power on again after making sure that the charge lamp has turned off completely. Large load inertia moment causes the servo motor shaft to oscillate side to side.
Chapter 7
10 - 4
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
10.2 When alarm or warning has occurred POINT As soon as an alarm occurs, turn off Servo-on (SON) and power off the power supply. 10.2.1 Alarms and warning list When a fault occurs during operation, the corresponding alarm or warning is displayed. If any alarm or warning has occurred, refer to section 10.2.2 or 10.2.3 and take the appropriate action. When an alarm occurs, the current circuit between ALM and VIN opens. Set " 1" in parameter No.49 to output the alarm code in ON/OFF status across the corresponding pin and VIN. Warnings (AL.96 to AL.E9) have no alarm codes. Any alarm code is output at occurrence of the corresponding alarm. In the normal status, the signals available before alarm code setting (CN1-12: ZSP, CN111: RD, CN1-10: INP or SA) are output. After its cause has been removed, the alarm can be deactivated in any of the methods marked in the alarm deactivation column.
(Note 2) Alarm code Display CN1-10 pin CN1-11 pin CN1-12 pin Name Alarm deactivation Power OFF ON Press "SET" on current alarm screen. Alarm reset (RES) signal
Warnings
AL.10 AL.12 AL.13 AL.15 AL.16 AL.17 AL.19 AL.1A AL.20 AL.24 AL.30 AL.31 AL.32 AL.33 AL.35 AL.37 AL.45 AL.46 AL.50 AL.51 AL.52 AL.8A AL.8E 88888 AL.E0 AL.E1 AL.E6
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
Undervoltage Memory error 1 Clock error Memory error 2 Encoder error 1 Board error Memory error 3 Motor combination error Encoder error 2 Main circuit error Regenerative error Overspeed Overcurrent Overvoltage Command pulse frequency error Parameter error Main circuit device overheat Servo motor overheat Overload 1 Overload 2 Error excessive Serial communication time-out error Serial communication error Watchdog Excessive regenerative warning Overload warning Servo emergency stop warning
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
Alarms
AL.E9 Undervoltage warning Note 1. Deactivate the alarm about 30 minutes of cooling time after removing the cause of occurrence. 2. 0: off 1: on
10 - 5
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
10.2.2 Remedies for alarms When any alarm has occurred, eliminate its cause, ensure safety, then reset the alarm, and restart operation. Otherwise, injury may occur. As soon as an alarm occurs, turn off Servo-on (SON) and power off the power supply. POINT When any of the following alarms has occurred, always remove its cause and allow about 30 minutes for cooling before resuming operation. If operation is resumed by switching power off, then on to reset the alarm, the servo amplifier and servo motor may become faulty. Regenerative error (AL.30) Overload 1 (AL.50) Overload 2 (AL.51) The alarm can be deactivated by switching power off, then on press the "SET" button on the current alarm screen or by turning on the reset signal (RES). For details, refer to section 10.2.1. When an alarm occurs, the trouble signal (ALM) switches off and the dynamic brake is operated to stop the servo motor. At this time, the display indicates the alarm No. The servo motor comes to a stop. Remove the cause of the alarm in accordance with this section. Use the optional MR Configurator (servo configuration software) to refer to the cause of the alarm.
Display AL.10 Name Undervoltage Definition Power supply voltage dropped to 160VAC or less. Cause 1. Power supply voltage is low. 2. There was an instantaneous control power failure of 60ms or longer. 3. Shortage of power supply capacity caused the power supply voltage to drop at start, etc. 4. The bus voltage dropped to 200VDC. 5. Faulty parts in the servo amplifier AL.12 AL.13 AL.15 Memory error 1 Clock error Memory error 2 RAM, memory fault Printed board fault EEP-ROM fault 1. Faulty parts in the servo amplifier 2. The number of write times to EEPROM exceeded 100,000. AL.16 Encoder error 1 Communication error 1. Encoder connector (CN2) occurred between disconnected. encoder and servo 2. Encoder fault amplifier. 3. Encoder cable faulty (Wire breakage or shorted) CPU/parts fault 1. Faulty parts in the servo amplifier The output terminals 2. The wiring of U, V, W is U, V, W of the servo disconnected or not connected. amplifier and the input terminals U, V, W of the servo motor are not connected. ROM memory fault Faulty parts in the servo amplifier Connect correctly. Change the servo motor. Repair or change cable. Change the servo amplifier. Correctly connect the output terminals U, V, W of the servo amplifier and the input terminals U, V, W of the servo motor. Change the servo amplifier. Faulty parts in the servo amplifier Change the servo amplifier. Change the servo amplifier. Action Check the power supply.
CAUTION
AL.17
Board error
AL.19
Memory error 3
10 - 6
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Definition Wrong combination of servo amplifier and servo motor. Communication error occurred between encoder and servo amplifier. Ground fault occurred at the servo motor powers (U,V and W phases) of the servo amplifier.
Cause Wrong combination of servo amplifier and servo motor connected. 1. Encoder connector (CN2) disconnected. 2. Encoder fault 3. Encoder cable faulty (Wire breakage or shorted) 1. Power input wires and servo motor power wires are in contact at main circuit terminal block (TE1). 2. Sheathes of servo motor power cables deteriorated, resulting in ground fault. 3. Main circuit of servo amplifier failed. Checking method Alarm (AL.24) occurs if the servo is switched on after disconnecting the U, V, W power cables from the servo amplifier. 1. Wrong setting of parameter No.0 2. Built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option is not connected. 3. High-duty operation or continuous regenerative operation caused the permissible regenerative power of the regenerative option to be exceeded. Checking method Call the status display and check the regenerative load ratio. 4. Power supply voltage is abnormal. MR-E- A-QW003: 260VAC or more 5. Built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option faulty.
Action Use correct combination. Connect correctly. Change the servo motor. Repair or change the cable. Connect correctly. Change the cable.
AL.24
AL.30
Regenerative error
Permissible regenerative power of the built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option is exceeded.
Set correctly. Connect correctly. 1. Reduce the frequency of positioning. 2. Use the regenerative option of larger capacity. 3. Reduce the load.
Check the power supply. Change servo amplifier or regenerative option. Change the servo amplifier.
10 - 7
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Display AL.31
Name Overspeed
Cause 1. Input command pulse frequency exceeded the permissible instantaneous speed frequency.
2. Small acceleration/deceleration time Increase acceleration/deceleration time constant. constant caused overshoot to be large. 3. Servo system is instable to cause overshoot. 1. Re-set servo gain to proper value. 2. If servo gain cannot be set to proper value. 1) Reduce load inertia moment ratio; or 2) Reexamine acceleration/ deceleration time constant. Set correctly. Change the servo motor. Correct the wiring. Change the servo amplifier.
4. Electronic gear ratio is large (parameters No.3, 4) 5. Encoder faulty. AL.32 Overcurrent Current that flew is higher than the permissible current of the servo amplifier. (When the alarm (AL.32) occurs, switch the power OFF and then ON to reset the alarm. Then, turn on the servo-on. When the alarm (AL.32) still occurs at the time, the transistor (IPM IGBT) of the servo amplifier may be at fault. Do not switch the power OFF/ON repeatedly; check the transistor according to the cause 2 checking method.) Converter bus voltage exceeded 400VDC. 1. Short occurred in servo amplifier output phases U, V and W. 2. Transistor (IPM) of the servo amplifier faulty.
Checking method Alarm (AL.32) occurs if power is switched on after U,V and W are disconnected.
3. Ground fault occurred in servo amplifier output phases U, V and W. 4. External noise caused the overcurrent detection circuit to misoperate.
AL.33
Overvoltage
1. Regenerative option is not used. 2. Though the regenerative option is used, the parameter No.0 setting is " 0 (not used)". 3. Lead of built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option is open or disconnected. 4. Regenerative transistor faulty.
1. For wire breakage of built-in regenerative 5. Wire breakage of built-in resistor, change the servo amplifier. regenerative resistor or regenerative 2. For wire breakage of regenerative option, option change the regenerative option. 6. Capacity of built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option is insufficient. 7. Power supply voltage high. Add regenerative option or increase capacity. Check the power supply.
10 - 8
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Display AL.35
Name
Definition
Cause 1. Pulse frequency of the command pulse is too high. 2. Noise entered command pulses. 3. Command device failure 1. Servo amplifier fault caused the parameter setting to be rewritten. 2. Regenerative option or servo motor not used with servo amplifier was selected in parameter No.0. 3. The number of write times to EEPROM exceeded 100,000 due to parameter write, etc.
Action Change the command pulse frequency to a proper value. Take action against noise. Change the command device. Change the servo amplifier. Set parameter No.0 correctly.
Input pulse Command pulse frequency frequency of the command pulse is error too high. Parameter error Parameter setting is wrong.
AL.37
AL.45
1. Servo amplifier faulty. 2. The power supply was turned on and off continuously by overloaded status. 3. Air cooling fan of servo amplifier stops.
1. Exchange the cooling fan or the servo amplifier. 2. Reduce ambient temperature. Review environment so that ambient temperature is 0 to 40 (104 ). 1. Reduce load. 2. Review operation pattern. 3. Use servo motor that provides larger output. Change the servo motor. 1. Reduce load. 2. Review operation pattern. 3. Use servo motor that provides larger output. 1. Repeat acceleration/ deceleration to execute auto tuning. 2. Change auto tuning response setting. 3. Set auto tuning to OFF and make gain adjustment manually. 1. Review operation pattern. 2. Install limit switches. Connect correctly.
AL.46
3. Thermal sensor in encoder is faulty. AL.50 Overload 1 Load exceeded overload protection characteristic of servo amplifier. 1. Servo amplifier is used in excess of its continuous output current.
3. Machine struck something. 4. Wrong connection of servo motor. Servo amplifier's output terminals U, V, W do not match servo motor's input terminals U, V, W. 5. Encoder faulty.
Checking method When the servo motor shaft is rotated with the servo off, the cumulative feedback pulses do not vary in proportion to the rotary angle of the shaft but the indication skips or returns midway.
10 - 9
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
Display AL.51
Name Overload 2
Definition
Cause
Machine collision or 1. Machine struck something. the like caused max. output current to flow 2. Wrong connection of servo motor. successively for Servo amplifier's output terminals U, several seconds. V, W do not match servo motor's Servo motor locked: input terminals U, V, W. 1s or more 3. Servo system is instable and During rotation: hunting. 2.5s or more
1. Repeat acceleration/deceleration to execute auto tuning. 2. Change auto tuning response setting. 3. Set auto tuning to OFF and make gain adjustment manually. Change the servo motor.
4. Encoder faulty.
Checking method When the servo motor shaft is rotated with the servo off, the cumulative feedback pulses do not vary in proportion to the rotary angle of the shaft but the indication skips or returns midway.
AL.52
Error excessive
The difference between the model position and the actual servo motor position exceeds 2.5 rotations. (Refer to the function block diagram in section 1.2)
1. Acceleration/deceleration time constant is too small. 2. Torque limit value (parameter No.28) is too small. 3. Motor cannot be started due to torque shortage caused by power supply voltage drop. 4. Position control gain 1 (parameter No.6) value is small. 5. Servo motor shaft was rotated by external force.
Increase the acceleration/deceleration time constant. Increase the torque limit value. 1. Review the power supply capacity. 2. Use servo motor which provides larger output. Increase set value and adjust to ensure proper operation. 1. When torque is limited, increase the limit value. 2. Reduce load. 3. Use servo motor that provides larger output. 1. Review operation pattern. 2. Install limit switches. Change the servo motor. Connect correctly.
6. Machine struck something. 7. Encoder faulty 8. Wrong connection of servo motor. Servo amplifier's output terminals U, V, W do not match servo motor's input terminals U, V, W. AL.8A Serial communication time-out error RS-232C or RS-422 communication stopped for longer than the time set in parameter No.56. Serial communication error occurred between servo amplifier and communication device (e.g. personal computer). CPU, parts faulty 1. Communication cable breakage. 2. Communication cycle longer than parameter No.56 setting. 3. Wrong protocol. 1. Communication cable fault (Open cable or short circuit) 2. Communication device (e.g. personal computer) faulty
Repair or change communication cable. Set correct value in parameter. Correct protocol. Repair or change the cable. Change the communication device (e.g. personal computer).
AL.8E
88888
Watchdog
10 - 10
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
10.2.3 Remedies for warnings POINT When any of the following alarms has occurred, do not resume operation by switching power of the servo amplifier OFF/ON repeatedly. The servo amplifier and servo motor may become faulty. If the power of the servo amplifier is switched OFF/ON during the alarms, allow more than 30 minutes for cooling before resuming operation. Excessive regenerative warning (AL.E0) Overload warning 1 (AL.E1) If AL.E6 occurs, the servo off status is established. If any other warning occurs, operation can be continued but an alarm may take place or proper operation may not be performed. Use the optional MR Configurator (servo configuration software) to refer to the cause of the warning.
Display Name Definition There is a possibility that regenerative power may exceed permissible regenerative power of built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option. Cause Regenerative power increased to 85 or more of permissible regenerative power of built-in regenerative resistor or regenerative option. Checking method Call the status display and check regenerative load ratio. Action 1. Reduce frequency of positioning. 2. Change regenerative option for the one with larger capacity. 3. Reduce load.
AL.E1 Overload warning There is a possibility that overload alarm 1 or 2 may occur. AL.E6 Servo emergency EMG-VIN are open. stop warning AL.E9 Undervoltage warning This alarm occurs when the servo motor speed decreases to or below 50r/min with the bus voltage dropping.
Load increased to 85 or more of overload Refer to AL.50, AL.51. alarm 1 or 2 occurrence level.
Cause, checking method Refer to AL.50, 51.
Ensure safety and deactivate emergency stop. Check the power supply.
10 - 11
10. TROUBLESHOOTING
MEMO
10 - 12
50
Approx.70
135
168
Mounting Screw Screw Size: M5 Tightening torque: 3.24 [N m] (28.676 [lb in])
11 - 1
156
70
Approx.70
135
6
168
22
Mounting Screw Screw Size: M5 Tightening torque: 3.24 [N m] (28.676 [lb in])
11 - 2
156
70
Approx. 70 25
190
6
159
168
42
22
Mounting Screw Screw Size: M5 Tightening torque: 3.24 [N m] (28.676 [lb in])
11 - 3
156
(4) MR-E-200A-QW003
[Unit: mm]
90
Approx. 70 40
195
6
156
168
78
Mounting Screw Screw Size: M5 Tightening torque: 3.24 [N m] (28.676 [lb in])
CNP2 U V W
11 - 4
156
11.2 Connectors (1) Miniature delta ribbon (MDR) system (3M) (a) One-touch lock type
[Unit: mm]
E
39.0 23.8
12.7
Connector 10126-3000PE
Connector 10126-3000PE
11 - 5
: 54599-1019
[Unit: mm]
40 12.5
22.7
11
11 - 6
51240-0300 51240-0600
17.8 32.8
10 25
3 6
8.5
25
11.4
0.5
15.3
51241-0300 51241-0600
7.5 Pitch
A (B) 3.75
8.5
25
11.4
0.5
15.3
11 - 7
54927-0310
Housing Housing cover
54927-0610
14.3
54928-0310 54928-0610
21.5 44
22.5 37.5
3 6
14.3
11 - 8
12. CHARACTERISTICS
12. CHARACTERISTICS
12.1 Overload protection characteristics An electronic thermal relay is built in the servo amplifier to protect the servo motor and servo amplifier from overloads. Overload 1 (AL.50) occurs if overload operation performed is above the electronic thermal relay protection curve shown in any of Figs 12.1, Overload 2 (AL.51) occurs if the maximum current flew continuously for several seconds due to machine collision, etc. Use the equipment on the left-hand side area of the continuous or broken line in the graph. In a machine like the one for vertical lift application where unbalanced torque will be produced, it is recommended to use the machine so that the unbalanced torque is 70% or less of the rated torque.
1000 During rotation 100 Operation time[s] 100 Operation time[s] 1000 During rotation
10
10
0.1 0 50 150 100 200 (Note) Load ratio [%] 250 300
0.1 0 50 150 100 200 (Note) Load ratio [%] 250 300
a. MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100A-QW003
b. MR-E-200A-QW003
Note. If operation that generates torque more than 100% of the rating is performed with an abnormally high frequency in a servo motor stop status (servo lock status) or in a 30r/min or less low-speed operation status, the servo amplifier may fail even when the electronic thermal relay protection is not activated.
Fig 12.1 Electronic thermal relay protection characteristics 12.2 Power supply equipment capacity and generated loss (1) Amount of heat generated by the servo amplifier Table 12.1 indicates servo amplifiers' power supply capacities and losses generated under rated load. For thermal design of an enclosure, use the values in Table 12.1 in consideration for the worst operating conditions. The actual amount of generated heat will be intermediate between values at rated torque and zero torque according to the duty used during operation. When the servo motor is run at less than the maximum speed, the power supply capacity will be smaller than the value in the table, but the servo amplifier's generated heat will not change. Table 12.1 Power supply capacity and generated heat per servo amplifier at rated output
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 Servo motor HF-KE13W1-S100 HF-KE23W1-S100 HF-KE43W1-S100 HF-SE52JW1-S100 HF-KE73W1-S100 HF-SE102JW1-S100 HF-SE152JW1-S100 HF-SE202JW1-S100 (Note 1) Power supply capacity [kVA] 0.3 0.5 0.9 1.0 1.3 1.7 2.5 3.5 (Note 2) Servo amplifier-generated heat [W] At rated torque With servo off 25 25 35 40 50 50 90 90 15 15 15 15 15 15 20 20 Area required for heat dissipation [m2] 0.5 0.5 0.7 0.8 1.0 1.0 1.8 1.8
Note 1. Note that the power supply capacity will vary according to the power supply impedance. This value assumes that the power factor improving reactor is not used. 2. Heat generated during regeneration is not included in the servo amplifier-generated heat. To calculate heat generated by the regenerative option, refer to section 13.1.1.
12 - 1
12. CHARACTERISTICS
(2) Heat dissipation area for enclosed servo amplifier The enclosed control box (hereafter called the control box) which will contain the servo amplifier should be designed to ensure that its temperature rise is within 10 at the ambient temperature of 40 (104 ). (With a 5 (41 ) safety margin, the system should operate within a maximum 55 (131 ) limit.) The necessary enclosure heat dissipation area can be calculated by Equation 12.1.
P ....................................................................................................................................................(12.1) K T 2 where, A : Heat dissipation area [m ] P : Loss generated in the control box [W] T : Difference between internal and ambient temperatures [ ] K : Heat dissipation coefficient [5 to 6]
When calculating the heat dissipation area with Equation 12.1, assume that P is the sum of all losses generated in the enclosure. Refer to Table 12.1 for heat generated by the servo amplifier. "A" indicates the effective area for heat dissipation, but if the enclosure is directly installed on an insulated wall, that extra amount must be added to the enclosure's surface area. The required heat dissipation area will vary wit the conditions in the enclosure. If convection in the enclosure is poor and heat builds up, effective heat dissipation will not be possible. Therefore, arrangement of the equipment in the enclosure and the use of a cooling fan should be considered. Table 12.1 lists the enclosure dissipation area for each servo amplifier when the servo amplifier is operated at the ambient temperature of 40 (104 ) under rated load.
(Outside) (Inside)
Air flow
Fig. 12.2 Temperature distribution in enclosure When air flows along the outer wall of the enclosure, effective heat exchange will be possible, because the temperature slope inside and outside the enclosure will be steeper.
12 - 2
12. CHARACTERISTICS
12.3 Dynamic brake characteristics Fig. 12.3 shows the pattern in which the servo motor comes to a stop when the dynamic brake is operated. Use Equation 12.2 to calculate an approximate coasting distance to a stop. The dynamic brake time constant varies with the servo motor and machine operation speeds. (Refer to Fig. 12.4)
Emergency stop(EMG) ON OFF
V0 Machine speed
Time constant
te
Time
Lmax Lmax Vo JM JL te
JL V0 te 1 ............................................................................................................................(12.2) 60 JM : Maximum coasting distance................................................................................................................[mm] : Machine rapid feed rate................................................................................................................[mm/min] 2 2 : Servo motor inertial moment .......................................................................................... [kg cm ][oz in ] 2 2 : Load inertia moment converted into equivalent value on servo motor shaft ................ [kg cm ][oz in ] : Brake time constant................................................................................................................................. [s] : Delay time of control section ................................................................................................................... [s] (There is internal relay delay time of about 30ms.)
25 [ms] 20 15 10 13 5 0 0 43 1000 2000 3000 4000 5000 6000 Speed [r/min] 73 23
[ms] 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 0 102 202 152 500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 Speed [r/min] 52
Time constant
b. HF-SE JW1-S100 a. HF-KE W1-S100 Fig. 12.4 Dynamic brake time constant Use the dynamic brake under the load inertia moment ratio indicated in the following table. If the load inertia moment is higher than this value, the built-in dynamic brake may burn. If there is a possibility that the load inertia moment may exceed the value, contact Mitsubishi.
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-200A-QW003 Load inertia moment ratio [times] 30
12 - 3
Time constant
12. CHARACTERISTICS
12.4 Encoder cable flexing life The flexing life of the cables is shown below. This graph calculated values. Since they are not guaranteed values, provide a little allowance for these values.
1 108 5 107 a
1 107 5 106 a : Long flex life encoder cable Long flex life motor power cable Long flex life motor brake cable b : Standard encoder cable Standard motor power cable Standard motor brake cable
1 106 5 105
1 105 5 104
1 104 5 103
12.5 Inrush currents at power-on of main circuit and control circuit The following table indicates the inrush currents (reference value) that will flow when the maximum permissible voltage (253VAC) is applied at the power supply capacity of 2500kVA and the wiring length of 1m.
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 70A (Attenuated to approx. 20A in 10ms) 110A (Attenuated to approx. 20A in 10ms) 50A (Attenuated to approx. 10A in 10ms) Inrush currents (A0-p) Main circuit power supply (L1, L2, L3)
Since large inrush currents flow in the power supplies, always use circuit breakers and magnetic contactors. (Refer to section 13.2.2.) When circuit protectors are used, it is recommended to use the inertia delay type that will not be tripped by an inrush current.
12 - 4
WARNING
CAUTION
13.1 Options
CAUTION
The specified combinations of regenerative options and servo amplifiers may only be used. Otherwise, a fire may occur.
(1) Combination and regenerative power The power values in the table are resistor-generated regenerative powers and not rated powers.
Permissible regenerative power [W] Servo amplifier Built-in regenerative resistor MR-RB032 [40 ] 30 30 10 20 20 100 30 30 30 100 100 100 100 300 300 300 500 MR-RB12 [40 ] MR-RB32 [40 ] MR-RB30 [13 ] (Note) MR-RB50 [13 ]
(2) Selection of the regenerative option (a) Simple selection method In horizontal motion applications, select the regenerative option as described below. When the servo motor is run without load in the regenerative mode from the running speed to a stop, the permissible duty is as indicated in section 5.1 of the separately available Servo Motor Instruction Manual. For the servo motor with a load, the permissible duty changes according to the inertia moment of the load and can be calculated by the following formula.
Permissible duty Permissible duty for servo motor with no load (value indication section 5.1 in Servo Motor Instruction Manual) (m ratedspeed running speed where m
2
1)
[times/min]
From the permissible duty, find whether the regenerative option is required or not. Permissible duty number of positioning times [times/min] Select the regenerative option out of the combinations in (1) of this section.
13 - 1
(b) To make selection according to regenerative energy Use the following method when regeneration occurs continuously in vertical motion applications or when it is desired to make an in-depth selection of the regenerative option. a. Regenerative energy calculation Use the following table to calculate the regenerative energy.
Servo motor speed
tf(1 cycle) No Up Down
t1 Tpsa1 t2 Tpsd1 t3 Tpsa2
M Friction torque
TF TU
Unbalance torque
Time
t4 Tpsd2
( )
1) (Driving) 2) 4) 5) 6) 3) (Regenerative) 7) 8)
( )
Formulas for calculating torque and energy in operation Regenerative power 1) 2) 3) 4), 8) 5) 6) 7)
T1
Torque applied to servo motor [N m] (JL JM) N0 1 TU TF Tpsa1 9.55 104 TU TF (JL JM) N0 9.55 104
1 Tpsd1 1 Tpsa2 TU TF
Generated torque
Energy [J]
E1 0.1047 2 N0 T1 Tpsa1
T2
T3
E2
E3
0.1047 N0 T2 t1 0.1047 N0 T3 Tpsd1 2 0 (No regeneration) 0.1047 N0 T5 Tpsa2 2 0.1047 N0 T6 t3 0.1047 N0 T7 Tpsd2 2
T4
T5
E4
TU TF E5
T6
T7
E6
1 Tpsd2 TU TF E7
From the calculation results in 1) to 8), find the absolute value (Es) of the sum total of negative energies. b. Losses of servo motor and servo amplifier in regenerative mode The following table lists the efficiencies and other data of the servo motor and servo amplifier in the regenerative mode.
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 Inverse efficiency [ ] Capacitor charging [J] 55 70 85 80 80 85 9 9 11 18 18 40
Inverse efficiency ( )
:Efficiency including some efficiencies of the servo motor and servo amplifier when rated (regenerative) torque is generated at rated speed. Since the efficiency varies with the speed and torque, allow for about 10 . :Energy charged into the electrolytic capacitor in the servo amplifier.
13 - 2
Subtract the capacitor charging from the result of multiplying the sum total of regenerative energies by the inverse efficiency to calculate the energy consumed by the regenerative option. ER [J] Es Ec Calculate the power consumption of the regenerative option on the basis of single-cycle operation period tf [s] to select the necessary regenerative option. PR [W] ER/tf (3) Connection of the regenerative option Set parameter No.2 according to the option to be used.
Parameter No.0
For the servo amplifier of 200W or lower, lower, regenerative resistor is not used. For the servo amplifier of 400W or higher, built-in regenerative resistor is used.
2: MR-RB032 3: MR-RB12 4: MR-RB32 5: MR-RB30 6: MR-RB50 (Cooling fan is required)
(4) Connection of the regenerative option POINT When using the MR-RB50, cooling by a cooling fan is required. Please obtain a cooling fan at your discretion. The regenerative option will cause a temperature rise of 100 relative to the ambient temperature. Fully examine heat dissipation, installation position, used cables, etc. before installing the option. For wiring, use flame-resistant cables and keep them clear of the regenerative option body. Always use twisted cables of max. 5m length for connection with the servo amplifier. Always remove the wiring from across P-D and fit the regenerative option across P-C. The G3 and G4 terminals act as a thermal sensor. G3-G4 are disconnected when the regenerative option overheats abnormally.
Servo amplifier D P C (Note 2) 5m max. Always remove the lead from across P-D. Regenerative option P C G3 G4
(Note 1) Cooling fan Note 1. When using the MR-RB50, forcibly cool it with a cooling fan (92
92, minimum air flow: 1.0m3). 2. Make up a sequence which will switch off the magnetic contactor (MC) when abnormal heating occurs. G3-G4 contact specifications Maximum voltage: 120V AC/DC Maximum current: 0.5A/4.8VDC Maximum capacity: 2.4VA
13 - 3
LA LB
6 mounting hole
MR-RB
12
TE1
G3 G4 P C
156
168
12
144
6 20 LD LC
1.6
Tightening torque: 0.5 to 0.6 [N m](4 to 5 [lb in]) Mounting screw Screw size: M5 Tightening torque: 3.24[N m](28.68 [lb in])
Variable dimensions Mass LA LB LC LD [kg] [lb] 30 15 119 99 0.5 1.1 40 15 169 149 1.1 2.4
7 10 90 100
17
318 335
Mounting screw Screw : M6 Tightening torque: 5.4 [N m](47.79 [lb in]) Regenerative option Mass [kg] (lb) MR-RB30 MR-RB32 2.9 (6.4)
13 - 4
(c) MR-RB50
Cooling fan mounting screw (2-M3 screw) On opposite side 12.5 49 82.5 Terminal block [Unit: mm (in)]
162.5
Mounting screw Screw : M6 Tightening torque: 5.4 [N m](47.79 [lb in]) Wind blows in the arrow direction
133
200 217
17
12.5
2.3
162.5
13 - 5
13.1.2 Cables and connectors POINT Protective structure indicated for cables and connecters is for a cable or connector alone. When the cables and connectors are used to connect the servo amplifier and servo motor, and if protective structures of the servo amplifier and servo motor are lower than that of the cable and connector, specifications of the servo amplifier and servo motor apply. (1) Cable make-up The following cables are used for connection with the servo motor and other models. Those indicated by broken lines in the figure are not options.
Servo amplifier 9)
Operation panel
13) Analog monitor Personal computer 14) 12) 20) 21) 22) 23)
Controller
CNP1
Direct connection type (cable length 10m or less, IP65) 36) 37) 38) 39) Junction type (cable length more than 10m, IP20) Power supply 1) 2) 40) 41)
34) 35)
30) 31) 32) 33) 28) 29) 24) 25) 26) 27)
Servo motor HF-KE W1-S100 Power supply connector 18) 19) 22) 23) 15) 16) 17) 3) 4) 5) Brake Encoder connector connector Servo motor HF-SE JW1-S100 Power supply connector Brake connector Encoder connector
7) 8)
13 - 6
No. 1)
Model MR-EKCBL M-L Refer to (2) (a) in this section. Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
Description Housing: 1-172161-9 Connector pin: 170359-1 (Tyco Electronics or equivalent) Cable clamp: MTI-0002 (Toa Denki kogyo)
2)
3)
MR-EKCBL M-H Refer to (2) (a) in this section. MR-ESCBL M-L Refer to (2) (d) in this section.
Long flex life IP20 Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex) Plug: D/MS3106B20-29S Cable clamp: D/MS3057-12A (DDK) Standard flexing life IP20
4)
5)
MR-ESCBL M-H Refer to (2) (e) in this section. IP65/IP67MR-ENECBL M-H Receptacle: 36210-0100PL compliant encoder Refer to (2) (e) in Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 cable this section. (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
Long flex life IP20 Plug: D/MS3106A20-29S (D190) Cable clamp : CE3057-12A-3-D Back shell: CE02-20BS-S-D (DDK) Long flex life IP65 IP67 Not oilresistant.
6)
MR-ECNM
Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
Housing: 1-172161-9 Connector pin: 170359-1 (Tyco Electronics or equivalent) Cable clamp: MTI-0002 (Toa Denki kogyo)
IP20
7)
MR-ECNS
Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
IP20
8)
MR-ENECNS
Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 36310-3200-008 (3M) or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
Plug: D/MS3106A20-29S (D190) Cable clamp : CE3057-12A-3-D Back shell: CE02-20BS-S-D (DDK)
IP65 IP67
9)
13 - 7
No.
Product
Model MR-ECNP1-A (In units of 20 pcs. /box) Connector: 51240-0600 (Molex or equivalent)
10) Amplifier power supply connector set (Insulation displacement type) MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100AQW003 11) Amplifier power supply connector set (Insertion type) MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100AQW003 12) Analog monitor RS-232C branch cable 13) Analog monitor RS-232C connector 14) Communication cable
Insertion type
MR-E3CBL15-P
Connector: MP371/6
Connector: MJ372/6 (Marushin Musen Denki or equivalent) Connector: MP371/6 (Marushin Musen Denki or equivalent)
MR-ECN3 (In units of 20 pcs. /box) Refer to (3) in this section. QC30R2 Connector: MP371/6 (Mini-DIN 6-pin male) (Marushin Musen Denki or equivalent)
Analog monitor RS232C branch cable Analog monitor for RS-232C For connection with PC-AT compatible personal computer IP67
17) Brake connector set 18) Motor power supply connector (Insulation displacement type) MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100AQW003 19) Motor power supply connector (Insertion type) MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100AQW003
MR-BKCNS1
Plug: CE05-6A18-10SD-D-BSS Cable clamp: CE3057-10A-1-D (DDK) Example of applicable cable Wire size: 2mm2 (AWG14) to 3.5mm2 (AWG12) Cable finish D: 10.5 to 14.1mm Plug: CE05-6A22-22SD-D-BSS Cable clamp: CE3057-12A-1-D (DDK) Example of applicable cable Wire size: 5.5mm2 (AWG10) to 8mm2 (AWG8) Cable finish D: 12.5 to 16mm Straight plug: CM10-SP2S-L Socket contact: CM10-#22SC(S2)-100 (DDK) Connector: 51240-0300 (Molex or equivalent) Terminal: 56125-0128 (Molex or equivalent)
IP65 IP67
Insertion type
13 - 8
No. Product 20) Amplifier power supply connector set (Insulation displacement type) MR-E-200AQW003 21) Amplifier power supply connector set (Insertion type) MR-E-200AQW003 22) Motor power supply connector (Insulation displacement type) MR-E-200AQW003 23) Motor power supply connector (Insertion type) MR-E-200AQW003 24) Motor power supply cable
Insertion type
Insertion type
MR-PWS1CBL MA1-L Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-PWS1CBL MA1-H Refer to section 13.1.2 (4) for details. Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-PWS1CBL MA2-L Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-PWS1CBL MA2-H Refer to section 13.1.2 (4) for details. Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-PWS2CBL03MA1-L Cable length: 0.3m
IP65 Load side lead IP65 Load side lead Long flex life
IP65 Opposite-toload side lead IP65 Opposite-toload side lead Long flex life IP55 Load side lead
Refer to section 13.1.2 (4) for details. 29) Motor power supply cable MRPWS2CBL03M-A2L Cable length: 0.3m
Power supply connector HF-KE W1-S100
13 - 9
No. Product Model 30) Motor brake cable MR-BKS1CBL MA1-L Cable length: 2 5 10m 31) Motor brake cable MR-BKS1CBL MA1-H Cable length: 2 5 10m 32) Motor brake cable MR-BKS1CBL MA2-L Cable length: 2 5 10m
Description
Brake connector HF-KE W1-S100
Application IP65 Load side lead IP65 Load side lead Long flex life
IP65 Opposite-toload side lead IP65 Opposite-toload side lead Long flex life IP55 Load side lead
33) Motor brake cable MR-BKS1CBL MA2-H Refer to section 13.1.2 (5) for details. Cable length: 2 5 10m 34) Motor brake cable MR-BKS2CBL03MBrake connector A1-L Cable length: 0.3m HF-KE W1-S100
Refer to section 13.1.2 (5) for details. 35) Motor brake cable MR-BKS2CBL03MA2-L Cable length: 0.3m
Brake connector HF-KE W1-S100
Refer to section 13.1.2 (5) for details. 36) Encoder cable MR-J3ENCBL MA1-L Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-J3ENCBL MA1-H Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-J3ENCBL MA2-L Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-J3ENCBL MA2-H Cable length: 2 5 10m MR-J3JCBL03MA1-L Cable length: 0.3m
Encoder connector HF-KE W1-S100
IP65 Load side lead IP65 Opposite-toload side lead Long flex life IP65 Opposite-toload side lead IP65 Opposite-toload side lead Long flex life IP20 Load side lead
13 - 10
Description
Encoder connector HF-KE W1-S100
CAUTION
If you have fabricated the encoder cable, connect it correctly. Otherwise, not doing so may cause unexpected operation. POINT The encoder cable is not oil resistant. Refer to section 12.4 for the flexing life of the encoder cable. When the encoder cable is used, the sum of the resistance values of the cable used for P5 and the cable used for LG should be within 2.4 . When soldering the wire to the connector pin, insulate and protect the connection portion using heat-shrinkable tubing. When using the encoder cable of four-wire type communication system, set " in parameter No.20 to select the four-wire type. "1
Generally use the encoder cable available as our options. If the required length is not found in the options, fabricate the cable on the customer side. When fabricating an encoder cable, use the selection example of wires given in section 13.2.1 and the MRECNM connector set for encoder cable fabrication, and fabricate an encoder cable as shown in the wiring diagram. Refer to section 14.5 and choose the encode side connector according to the servo motor installation environment.
13 - 11
(a) MR-J3ENCBL M-A1-L/H MR-J3ENCBL M-A2-L/H These cables are encoder cables for the HF-KE W1-S100 series servo motors. The numerals in the part of the cable model. The cables of Cable Length field of the table are the symbols entered in the the lengths with the symbols are available.
Cable model MR-J3ENCBL MR-J3ENCBL MR-J3ENCBL MR-J3ENCBL M-A1-L M-A1-H M-A2-L M-A2-H Cable length 2m 2 2 2 2 5m 5 5 5 5 10m 10 10 10 10 20m 30m 40m 50m Protective structure IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 Flex life Standard Long flex life Standard Long flex life Application For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead
1) CN2
or
1)
Cable model MR-J3ENCBL M-A1-L Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 536310-3200-008 (3M)
(Note) Signal layout 2
LG
2) For encoder connector Connector: 1674320-1 Crimping tool for ground clip: 1596970-1 Crimping tool for receptacle contact: 1596847-1 (Tyco Electronics)
(Note) Signal layout 9 SHD 7 5 MR 3 P5 1 8 6 P5G 4 MRR 2
MR-J3ENCBL M-A1-H
4
MRR
6 5
8 7
10 9
4 3
MR
6 5
8 7
10 9
LG MRR
MR-J3ENCBL M-A2-L
P5
3
MR
MR-J3ENCBL M-A2-H
. Especially, pin 10 is provided for Note. Keep open the pins shown with Note. Keep open the pin manufacturer adjustment. If it is connected with any other pin, the servo shown with an . amplifier cannot operate normally.
13 - 12
(Note)
(b) MR-EKCBL
M-L/H POINT The following encoder cables are of four-wire type. When using any of these encoder cables, set parameter No.20 to "1 " to select the four-wire type. MR-EKCBL30M-L MR-EKCBL30M-H MR-EKCBL40M-H MR-EKCBL50M-H
The servo amplifier and servo motor cannot be connected with these cables only. The servo motor side encoder cable (MR-J3JCBL03M-A1-L or MR-J3JCBL03M-A2-L) is required. The numerals in the Cable Length field of the table are the symbols entered in the part of the cable model. The cables of the lengths with the symbols are available.
Cable model MR-EKCBL M-L Cable length 2m 5m 10m 20m 20 30m (Note) 30 (Note) (Note) (Note) 30 40 50 40m 50m Protective structure IP20 Flex life Standard Long flex life Application For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Use in combination with MR-J3JCBL03M-A1-L or MR-J3JCBL03M-A2-L.
MR-EKCBL
M-H
20
IP20
13 - 13
Cable model MR-EKCBL M-L Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 536310-3200-008 (3M)
(Note) Signal layout
2) Junction connector Housing: 1-172161-9 Connector pin: 170359-1 (Tyco Electronics or equivalent) Cable clamp: MTI-0002 (Toa Electric Industries)
Signal layout
9
1 2 3 MR MRR 4 5 6 MD MDR CONT 7 8 9 P5 LG SHD
MR-EKCBL
M-H
2
LG
4
MRR
6 5
8
MDR
10 9
4 3
MR
6 5
8
MDR
10
LG MRR
1
P5
3
MR
7
MD
7
MD
. Especially, pin 10 is provided for Note. Keep open the pins shown with manufacturer adjustment. If it is connected with any other pin, the servo amplifier cannot operate normally.
13 - 14
MR MRR SD
3 4 9 Plate
(Note)
1 2 3 9
MR MRR SHD
MR MRR MD MDR
3 4 7 8 9 Plate
SD
(Note)
1 2 4 5 3 6 9
MR-EKCBL30M-H MR-EKCBL40M-H MR-EKCBL50M-H Servo amplifier side P5 LG 1 2 Encoder side 7 8 P5E P5G
MR MRR SD
3 4 9 Plate (Note)
1 2 3 9
MR MRR SHD MR MRR MD MDR 3 4 7 8 9 Plate (Note) 1 2 4 5 3 6 9 MR MRR MD MDR CONT SHD
SD
When fabricating the cable, use the wiring diagram corresponding to the length indicated below.
Cable flex life Standard Long flex life Applicable wiring diagram Less than 10m MR-EKCBL20M-L MR-EKCBL20M-H MR-EKCBL30M-H MR-EKCBL40M-H MR-EKCBL50M-H 30m to 50m
13 - 15
3) When fabricating the encoder cable When fabricating the cable, prepare the following parts and tool, and fabricate it according to the wiring diagram in 2). Refer to section 13.2.1 for the specifications of the used cable.
Parts/tool Connector set MR-ECNM Description
Servo amplifier side connector Receptacle: 36210-0100PL Shell kit: 536310-3200-008 (3M) Or Connector set: 54599-1019 (Molex)
Encoder side connector Housing: 1-172161-9 Connector pin: 170359-1 (Tyco Electronics or equivalent) Cable clamp: MTI-0002 (Toa Electric Industries)
(c) MR-J3JCBL03M-A1-L MR-J3JCBL03M-A2-L The servo amplifier and servo motor cannot be connected with these cables only. The servo motor side encoder cable (MR-EKCBL M-L/H) is required.
Cable model MR-J3JCBL03M-A1-L Cable length Protective structure Flex life Application For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead Use in combination with MR-EKCBL M-L/H. For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead Use in combination with MR-EKCBL M-L/H.
MR-J3JCBL03M-A2-L
0.3m
IP20
Standard
13 - 16
(d) MR-ESCBL M-L (standard flex life model) These encoder cables are used with the HF-SE JW1-S100 servo motors. 1) Model explanation
Model: MR-ESCBL M-L Standard flex life Symbol 2 5 10 20 30 Note. Set "1 Cable length 2 5 10 20 30 Communication system
2) Connection diagram For the pin assignment on the servo amplifier side, refer to section 3.3.1.
Servo amplifier Encoder connector Encoder cable (Optional or fabricated) CN2 Servo motor L Encoder Encoder connector M AB N P K T J S R H G C D E F Pin Signal MD A MDR B C MR MRR D E F G H J Pin Signal K L M CONT N SHD P R LG P5 S T
50m max.
a) Encoder cable of less than 30m When fabricating an encoder cable, use the MR-ECNS connector set. Referring to the following wiring diagram, you can fabricate an encoder cable of up to less than 30m.
MR-ESCBL2M-L MR-ESCBL5M-L MR-ESCBL10M-L Servo amplifier side AWG23 Encoder side P5 LG 1 2 S P5E R P5G MR-ESCBL20M-L
MR MRR
3 4
C MR D MRR
MR MRR
3 4
C MR D MRR
9 (Note) SD Plate
9 (Note)
N SHD
SD
Plate
N SHD
13 - 17
b) Encoder cable of 30m or more POINT The communication system of the encoder cable in this wiring diagram is the four-wire type. Set "1 " in parameter No.20. When fabricating an encoder cable, use the MR-ECNS connector set. Referring to the following wiring diagram, you can fabricate an encoder cable of up to 50m.
MR-ESCBL30M-L Servo amplifier side Encoder side P5 LG 1 2 S P5E R P5G
MR MRR MD MDR
3 4 7 8 9 (Note)
C D A B F M
SD
Plate
N SHD
13 - 18
(e) MR-ESCBL M-H (long flex life model) MR-ENECBL M-H (IP65/IP67-compatible, long flex life model) These encoder cables are used with the HC-SFE series servo motors. 1) Model explanation
Model: MR-ESCBL M-H Long flex life Symbol 2 5 10 20 30 40 50 Note. Set "1 Cable length 2 5 10 20 30 40 50 Communication system
Two-wire type
Model: MR-ENECBL
Two-wire type
13 - 19
2) Connection diagram For the pin assignment on the servo amplifier side, refer to section 3.3.1.
Servo amplifier Encoder connector Encoder cable (Optional or fabricated) CN2 Servo motor L Encoder Encoder connector M N AB C Pin Signal A MD B MDR C MR MRR D E F G H J Pin Signal K L M CONT N SHD P R LG P5 S T
K T J
P D S R E H F G
50m max.
a) Encoder cable of less than 30m When fabricating an encoder cable, use the MR-ECNS (IP20-compatible model) or MR-ENECNS (IP65/IP67-compatible model) connector set. Referring to the following wiring diagram, you can fabricate an encoder cable of up to less than 30m.
MR-ESCBL2M-H MR-ESCBL5M-H MR-ESCBL10M-H MR-ENECBL2M-H MR-ENECBL5M-H MR-ENECBL10M-H Servo amplifier side Encoder side P5 LG 1 2 S P5E R P5G
MR-ESCBL20M-H MR-ENECBL20M-H
MR MRR
3 4
C MR D MRR
MR MRR
3 4
C MR D MRR
9 (Note) SD Plate
9 (Note)
N SHD
SD
Plate
N SHD
13 - 20
b) Encoder cable of 30m or more POINT The communication system of the encoder cable in this wiring diagram is the four-wire type. Set "1 " in parameter No.20. When fabricating an encoder cable, use the MR-ECNS (IP20-compatible model) or MR-ENECNS (IP65/IP67-compatible model) connector set. Referring to the following wiring diagram, you can fabricate an encoder cable of up to 50m.
MR-ESCBL30M-H MR-ESCBL40M-H MR-ESCBL50M-H MR-ENECBL30M-H MR-ENECBL40M-H MR-ENECBL50M-H Servo amplifier side Encoder side P5 LG 1 2 S P5E R P5G
MR MRR MD MDR
3 4 7 8 9 (Note)
C D A B F M
SD
Plate
N SHD
13 - 21
(3) Communication cable POINT This cable may not be used with some personal computers. After fully examining the signals of the RS-232C connector, refer to this section and fabricate the cable. (a) Model definition Model: QC30R2 (Cable length 3[m]) (b) Connection diagram for fabrication
MR-CPCATCBL3M Personal computer side TXD RXD GND RTS CTS DSR DTR 3 2 5 7 8 6 4 Servo amplifier side Plate 1 3 2 SD RXD LG TXD
D-SUB9 pins
When fabricating the cable, refer to the connection diagram in this section. Though this connection diagram is not the connection diagram of the QC30R2, it is identical in functions. The following must be observed in fabrication. 1) Always use a shielded, multi-core cable and connect the shield with SD securely. 2) The optional communication cable is 3m long. When the cable is fabricated, its maximum length is 15m in offices of good environment with minimal noise.
13 - 22
(4) Motor power supply cables These cables are motor power supply cables for the HF-KE W1-S100 servo motors. The numerals in the part of the cable model. The cables of the Cable Length field of the table are the symbols entered in the lengths with the symbols are available. Refer to section 3.8 when wiring.
Cable model MR-PWS1CBL M-A1-L MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-L MR-PWS1CBL M-A1-H MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-H MR-PWS2CBL M-A1-L MR-PWS2CBL M-A2-L 03 03 Cable length 0.3m 2m 2 2 2 2 5m 5 5 5 5 10m 10 10 10 10 Protective structure IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 IP55 IP55 Flex life Standard Standard Long flex life Long flex life Standard Standard Application For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead
13 - 23
1)
or CN2 For motor power supply connector MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-L MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-H MR-PWS2CBL03M-A2-L
M-A1-L Connector: JN4FT04SJ1-R Hod, socket insulator M-A2-L Bushing, ground nut Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100-(A534G) M-A1-H Crimping tool: CT160-3-TMH5B M-A2-H (Japan Aviation Electronics Industry) Connector: JN4FT04SJ2-R Hod, socket insulator Bushing, ground nut Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100-(A534G) Crimping tool: CT160-3-TMH5B (Japan Aviation Electronics Industry)
MR-PWS2CBL03M-A1-L
MR-PWS2CBL03M-A2-L
13 - 24
(5) Motor brake cables These cables are motor brake cables for the HF-KE W1-S100 servo motors. The numerals in the Cable part of the cable model. The cables of the lengths Length field of the table are the symbols entered in the with the symbols are available. Refer to section 3.8 when wiring.
Cable model MR-PWS1CBL M-A1-L MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-L MR-PWS1CBL M-A1-H MR-PWS1CBL M-A2-H MR-PWS2CBL M-A1-L MR-PWS2CBL M-A2-L 03 03 Cable length 0.3m 2m 2 2 2 2 5m 5 5 5 5 10m 10 10 10 10 Protective structure IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 IP55 IP55 Flex life Standard Standard Long flex life Long flex life Standard Standard Application For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Load side lead For HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor Opposite-to-load side lead
13 - 25
or
Cable model MR-BKS1CBL M-A1-L MR-BKS1CBL M-A2-L MR-BKS1CBL M-A1-H MR-BKS1CBL M-A2-H MR-BKS2CBL03M-A1-L
1) For motor brake connector Connector: JN4FT02SJ1-R Hod, socket insulator Bushing, ground nut Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100-(A534G) Crimping tool: CT160-3-TMH5B (Japan Aviation Electronics Industry) Connector: JN4FT02SJ2-R Hod, socket insulator Bushing, ground nut Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100-(A534G) Crimping tool: CT160-3-TMH5B (Japan Aviation Electronics Industry)
Signal layout 1 B1 2 B2 View seen from wiring side.
MR-BKS2CBL03M-A2-L
13 - 26
13.1.3 Analog monitor, RS-232C branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P) (1) Usage The analog monitor, RS-232C branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P) is designed for use when a personal computer and analog monitor outputs are used at the same time.
Servo amplifier Analog monitor, RS-232C branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P) CN3 Communication cable (QC30R2)
MO2 LG MO1 LG
MO2 6 Plate SD
Plate SD
13 - 27
13.1.4 MR Configurator (servo configurations software) The MR Configurator (servo configurations software MRZJW3-SETUP154E, 154C) uses the communication function of the servo amplifier to perform parameter setting changes, graph display, test operation, etc. on a personal computer. (1) Specifications
Item Model Communication signal Baud rate [bps] System Monitor Alarm Diagnostic Parameters Test operation Advanced function File operation Others Description 154E: English, 154C: Chinese Conforms to RS-232C. 57600, 38400, 19200, 9600 Station selection, Automatic demo Display, high speed monitor, trend graph Minimum resolution changes with the processing speed of the personal computer. Display, history, amplifier data Digital I/O, no motor rotation, total power-on time, amplifier version info, motor information, tuning data, Automatic VC offset display, Axis name setting. Parameter list, turning, change list, detailed information Jog operation, positioning operation, Operation w/o motor, Forced output, Demo mode. Machine analyzer, gain search, machine simulation. Data read, save, print Automatic demo, help display
(2) System configuration (a) Components To use this MR Configurator (servo configurations software), the following components are required in addition to the servo amplifier and servo motor.
(Note 1) Description IBM PC-AT compatible where the English version and Chinese version of Windows 95, Windows 98, Windows Me, Windows NT Workstation 4.0, Windows 2000 Professional, Windows XP Professional and Windows XP Home Edition operates Processor: Pentium 133MHz or more (Windows 95, Windows 98, Windows NT Workstation 4.0, Windows 2000 Professional) Pentium 150MHz or more (Windows Me) (Note 2) Personal computer Pentium 300MHz or more (Windows XP Professional, Windows XP Home Edition) Memory: 16MB or more (Windows 95), 24MB or more (Windows 98) 32MB or more (Windows Me, Windows NT Workstation 4.0, Windows 2000 Professional) 128MB or more (Windows XP Professional, Windows XP Home Edition) Free hard disk space: 60MB or more Serial port used Windows 95, Windows 98, Windows Me, Windows NT Workstation 4.0, Windows 2000 Professional, OS Windows XP Professional, Windows XP Home Edition (English version, Chinese version) One whose resolution is 800 600 or more and that can provide a high color (16 bit) display. Connectable with Display the above personal computer. Keyboard Connectable with the above personal computer. Mouse Connectable with the above personal computer. Note that a serial mouse is not used. Printer Connectable with the above personal computer. Communication QC30R2 cable When this cannot be used, refer to section 13.1.2 (3) and fabricate. Note 1. Windows and Windows NT are the registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. Pentium is the registered trademarks of Intel Corporation. 2. On some personal computers, this MR Configurator (servo configurations software) may not run properly. Model
13 - 28
13.2 Auxiliary equipment Always use the devices indicated in this section or equivalent. To comply with the EN Standard or UL/C-UL (CSA) Standard, use the products which conform to the corresponding standard. 13.2.1 Selection example of wires (1) Wires for power supply wiring The following diagram shows the wires used for wiring. Use the wires given in this section or equivalent.
1) Power supply lead Power supply Servo amplifier L1 L2 L3 U V W 2) Motor power supply lead Servo motor U V W Motor
D C P
Note. When using the regenerative option, always remove the wiring across D-P.
The following table lists wire sizes. The wires used assume that they are 600V vinyl wires and the wiring distance is 30m max. If the wiring distance is over 30m, choose the wire size in consideration of voltage drop. Refer to section 3.11 for connection with the connector (CNP1, CNP2). The servo motor side connection method depends on the type and capacity of the servo motor. Refer to section 3.8. To enable the built-in regenerative brake, connect the wiring across D-P. (Refer to section 3.7.2 for the connection method.) To comply with the UL/C-UL (CSA) Standard, use UL-recognized copper wires rated at 60 (140 ) or more for wiring. Table 13.1 Selection example of wires
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 more. (Note) Wires [mm2] 1) L1 L2 L3 3) U V W 4) P C D 5) B1 B2
2 (AWG14)
1.25 (AWG16) 2 (AWG14) 2 (AWG14) (Note) 2.5 (AWG14) (221 ) or more), if AWG14 cable is used in ambient temperature 40 (104 ) or 1.25 (AWG16)
13 - 29
(2) Wires for cables When fabricating a cable, use the wire models given in the following table or equivalent. Table 13.2 Wires for option cables
Type Model Length [mm] Core size 2 [mm ] 0.3 MR-EKCBL M-L MR-ESCBL M-L 2 to 10 0.08 20 Encoder cable MR-EKCBL M-H MR-ESCBL M-H MR-ENECBL M-H 30 0.3 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.08 Number of cores 4 (2 pairs) 4 (2 pairs) 12 (6 pairs) 8 (4 pairs) 12 (6 pairs) 14 (7 pairs) 6 (3 pairs) Characteristics of one core
Structure Conductor Insulation coating [Wires/mm] resistance [ /mm] ODd [mm] (Note 1)
Wire model (Note 3) 20276 composite 4-pair shielded cable (A-TYPE) UL20276AWG#23 6 pair (BLACK) (Note 3) A14B2339 4P (Note 3) A14B2343 6P (Note 3) J14B0238 (0.2 7P) UL20276 AWG#28 3pair (BLACK)
1.3 0.67 1.2 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.38 8.2 7.2 7.2 8.0 4.6
2 to 10 20 30 to 50
Communication cable
QC30R2
2. Standard OD. Max. OD is about 10 greater. 3. Purchased from Toa Electric Industry
13 - 30
13.2.2 Circuit breakers, fuses, magnetic contactors Always use one circuit breaker and one magnetic contactor with one servo amplifier. When using a fuse instead of the circuit breaker, use the one having the specifications given in this section.
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 MR-E-20A-QW003 MR-E-40A-QW003 MR-E-70A-QW003 MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 Circuit breaker 30A frame 5A 30A frame 5A 30A frame 10A 30A frame 15A 30A frame 15A 30A frame 20A Class Fuse Current [A] Voltage AC [V] 10 10 15 15 15 15 Magnetic contactor
K5
250
S-N10
S-N18
13.2.3 Power factor improving reactors The input power factor is improved to be about 90 . For use with a 1-phase power supply, it may be slightly lower than 90 .
[Unit : mm] Servo amplifier MR-E- A-QW003 MR-E- AG-QW003 MC R S T FR-BAL X Y Z L1 L2 L3 Servo amplifier MR-E- A-QW003 MR-E- AG-QW003 MC R S T FR-BAL X Y Z L1 L2 L3
H 5(0.2)
RXSY T Z C W1
Note. Connect a 1-phase 200 to 230VAC power supply to L1, L2 and keep L3 open.
Dimensions [mm ] W 135 135 160 160 220 W1 120 120 145 145 200 H 115 115 140 140 192 D 59 69 71 91 90 D1 45 57 55 75 70
0 2.5 0 2.5 0 2.5 0 2.5 0 2.5
Mounting Terminal screw size screw size M4 M4 M4 M4 M5 M3.5 M3.5 M3.5 M3.5 M4
Mass [kg (lb)] 2.0 (4.4) 2.8 (6.17) 3.7 (8.16) 5.6 (12.35) 8.5 (18.74)
13 - 31
13.2.4 Relays The following relays should be used with the interfaces.
Interface Input signals (interface DI-1) signals Selection example To prevent defective contacts, use a relay for small signal (twin contacts). (Ex.) Omron: type G2A, MY Small relay with 12VDC or 24VDC of rating 40mA or less (Ex.) Omron: type MY
13.2.5 Surge absorbers A surge absorber is required for the electromagnetic brake. Use the following surge absorber or equivalent. Insulate the wiring as shown in the diagram.
Maximum rating Permissible circuit voltage AC[Vma] 140 Note. 1 time 8 DC[V] 180 20 s
(Example) ERZV10D221 (Matsushita Electric Industry) TNR-10V221K (Nippon chemi-con) Outline drawing [mm] (ERZ-C10DK221)
13.5
4.7 1.0
16.5
Vinyl tube
3.0 or less
30.0 or more
0.8
13 - 32
13 - 33
Route 1)
Route 2)
Noise radiated from servo motor cable Magnetic induction noise Static induction noise Noises transmitted through electric channels Routes 4) and 5)
Route 3)
Route 6)
Noise transmitted through power supply cable Noise sneaking from grounding cable due to leakage current
Route 7)
Route 8)
5)
7) 7) 2)
7)
1) Instrument Receiver 3)
Servo amplifier
2)
8) 6) 4) Sensor
Servo motor
3)
13 - 34
Suppression techniques When measuring instruments, receivers, sensors, etc. which handle weak signals and may malfunction due to noise and/or their signal cables are contained in a control box together with the servo amplifier or run near the servo amplifier, such devices may malfunction due to noises transmitted through the air. The following techniques are required. (1) Provide maximum clearance between easily affected devices and the servo amplifier. (2) Provide maximum clearance between easily affected signal cables and the I/O cables of the servo amplifier. (3) Avoid laying the power lines (Input cables of the servo amplifier) and signal cables side by side or bundling them together. (4) Insert a line noise filter to the I/O cables or a radio noise filter on the input line. (5) Use shielded wires for signal and power cables or put cables in separate metal conduits. When the power lines and the signal cables are laid side by side or bundled together, magnetic induction noise and static induction noise will be transmitted through the signal cables and malfunction may occur. The following techniques are required. (1) Provide maximum clearance between easily affected devices and the servo amplifier. (2) Provide maximum clearance between easily affected signal cables and the I/O cables of the servo amplifier. (3) Avoid laying the power lines (Input cables of the servo amplifier) and signal cables side by side or bundling them together. (4) Use shielded wires for signal and power cables or put the cables in separate metal conduits. When the power supply of peripheral devices is connected to the power supply of the servo amplifier system, noises produced by the servo amplifier may be transmitted back through the power supply cable and the devices may malfunction. The following techniques are required. (1) Insert the radio noise filter (FR-BIF) on the power cables (Input cables) of the servo amplifier. (2) Insert the line noise filter (FR-BSF01) on the power cables of the servo amplifier. When the cables of peripheral devices are connected to the servo amplifier to make a closed loop circuit, leakage current may flow to malfunction the peripheral devices. If so, malfunction may be prevented by disconnecting the grounding cable of the peripheral device.
1) 2) 3)
4) 5) 6)
7)
8)
(2) Noise reduction products (a) Data line filter Noise can be prevented by installing a data line filter onto the encoder cable, etc. For example, the ZCAT3035-1330 of TDK and the ESD-SR-25 of NEC Tokin make are available as data line filters. As a reference example, the impedance specifications of the ZCAT3035-1330 (TDK) are indicated below. This impedances are reference values and not guaranteed values.
Impedance [ ] 10 to 100MHz 80 100 to 500MHz 150
39 34 1 1 Loop for fixing the cable band [Unit: mm]
1 30 1
TDK
13 - 35
0.5
4 31
Note that a diode should be installed to a DC relay, DC valve or the like. Maximum voltage: Not less than 4 times the drive voltage of the relay or the like Maximum current: Not less than twice the drive current of the relay or the like
RA
Diode
(c) Cable clamp fitting (AERSBAN -SET) Generally, the earth of the shielded cable may only be connected to the connector's SD terminal. However, the effect can be increased by directly connecting the cable to an earth plate as shown below. Install the earth plate near the servo amplifier for the encoder cable. Peel part of the cable sheath to expose the external conductor, and press that part against the earth plate with the cable clamp. If the cable is thin, clamp several cables in a bunch. The clamp comes as a set with the earth plate.
cable
40
cutter
13 - 36
Outline drawing
[Unit: mm]
L or less 0.3
C A
10
0 0.2
35
24
(Note)M4 screw
6 35
22
Note. Screw hole for grounding. Connect it to the earth plate of the control box.
A 100 70
11
B 86 56
C 30
Clamp fitting A B
L 70 45
13 - 37
24
0.3 0
30
(d) Line noise filter (FR-BSF01) This filter is effective in suppressing noises radiated from the power supply side and output side of the servo amplifier and also in suppressing high-frequency leakage current (zero-phase current) especially within 0.5MHz to 5MHz band.
Connection diagram Use the line noise filters for wires of the main power supply (L1 L2 FR-BSF01 L3) and of the motor power supply (U V W). Pass each of the 3-phase wires through the line noise filter an equal number of times in the same direction. For the main power supply, the effect of the filter rises as the number of passes increases, but generally four passes would be appropriate. For the motor power supply, passes must be four times or less. Do not pass the grounding (earth) wire through the filter, or the effect of the filter will drop. Wind the wires by passing through the filter to satisfy the required number of passes as shown in Example 1. If the wires are too thick to wind, use two or more filters to have the required number of passes as shown in Example 2. Place the line noise filters as close to the servo amplifier as possible for their best performance. Example 1 NFB MC Servo amplifier
Power supply L1 Line noise filter (Number of turns: 4) Example 2 NFB MC Power supply L2 L3
Approx. 22.5
2- 5
Approx. 65 33
11.25 0.5
Servo amplifier L1
L2 Line noise L3 filter Two filters are used (Total number of turns: 4)
(e) Radio noise filter (FR-BIF)...for the input side only This filter is effective in suppressing noises radiated from the power supply side of the servo amplifier especially in 10MHz and lower radio frequency bands. The FR-BIF is designed for the input side only.
Connection diagram Make the connection cables as short as possible. Grounding is always required. When using the FR-BIF with a single-phase power supply, always insulate the wires that are not used for wiring.
NFB Power supply MC Servo amplifier L1 L2 L3
About 300
29
42
4.5
Approx. 65
5 hole
58
29 44
13 - 38
(f) Varistors for input power supply (Recommended) Varistors are effective to prevent exogenous noise and lightning surge from entering the servo amplifier. When using a varistor, connect it between each phase of the input power supply of the equipment. For varistors, the TND20V-431K and TND20V-471K, manufactured by NIPPON CHEMI-CON, are recommended. For detailed specification and usage of the varistors, refer to the manufacturer catalog.
Maximum rating Power supply voltage Varistor Permissible circuit voltage AC [Vrms] 100V class TND20V-431K 200V class TND20V-471K 275 300 DC [V] 350 385 Surge current immunity 8/20 s [A] 10000/1 time 7000/2 time Static Varistor voltage Maximum limit capacity rating (range) Energy Rated pulse voltage (reference V1mA immunity power value) 2ms [J] 195 215 [W] 1.0 [A] 100 [V] 710 775 [pF] 1300 1200 [V] 430(387 to 473) 470(423 to 517) [Unit: mm]
D T
Model TND20V-431K
H
D Max. 21.5
H Max. 24.5
(Note) L min. 20
d 0.05 0.8
W 1.0 10.0
TND20V-471K
Note. For special purpose items for lead length (L), contact the manufacturer.
W d E
13 - 39
13.2.7 Leakage current breaker (1) Selection method High-frequency chopper currents controlled by pulse width modulation flow in the AC servo circuits. Leakage currents containing harmonic contents are larger than those of the motor which is run with a commercial power supply. Select a leakage current breaker according to the following formula, and ground the servo amplifier, servo motor, etc. securely. Make the input and output cables as short as possible, and also make the grounding cable as long as possible (about 30cm) to minimize leakage currents. Rated sensitivity current
Cable Noise filter
NV
Type
Servo amplifier Cable M
Ig1 Ign
Iga
Ig2
Igm
General models
Leakage current on the electric channel from the leakage current breaker to the input terminals of the servo amplifier (Found from Fig. 13.1.) Leakage current on the electric channel from the output terminals of the servo amplifier to the servo motor (Found from Fig. 13.1.) Leakage current when a filter is connected to the input side (4.4mA per one FR-BIF) Leakage current of the servo amplifier (Found from Table 13.4.) Leakage current of the servo motor (Found from Table 13.3.)
120
Leakage current
Table 13.3 Servo motor's leakage current example (Igm) Servo motor output [kW] 0.1 to 1.0 1.0 to 2.2 Leakage current [mA] 0.1 0.2
Table 13.4 Servo amplifier's leakage current example (Iga) Servo amplifier capacity [kW] 0.1 to 0.6 0.7 to 2.0 Leakage current [mA] 0.1 0.15
[mA]
Fig. 13.1 Leakage current example (Ig1, Ig2) for CV cable run in metal conduit
13 - 40
(2) Selection example Indicated below is an example of selecting a leakage current breaker under the following conditions.
2mm2 5m NV Servo amplifier MR-E-40A-QW003 M Servo motor HF-KE43W1-S100 2mm2 5m
Ig1
Iga
Ig2
Igm
Use a leakage current breaker generally available. Find the terms of Equation (13.1) from the diagram.
Ig1
20
5 1000 5 1000
0.1 [mA]
20
0.1 [mA]
Insert these values in Equation (13.1). Ig 10 {0.1 0 0.1 1 (0.1 0.1)} 4.0 [mA] According to the result of calculation, use a leakage current breaker having the rated sensitivity current (Ig) of 4.0 [mA] or more. A leakage current breaker having Ig of 15 [mA] is used with the NVSP/SW/CP/CW/HW series.
13 - 41
13.2.8 EMC filter For compliance with the EMC Directive of the EN Standard, it is recommended to use the following filter. Some EMC filters are large in leakage current. (1) Combination with the servo amplifier
Servo amplifier MR-E-10A-QW003 to MR-E-100A-QW003 MR-E-200A-QW003 Recommended filter Model SF1252 SF1253 Leakage current [mA] 38 57 Mass [kg]([lb]) 0.75 (1.65) 1.37 (1.65)
Note 1. For 1-phase 230VAC power supply, connect the power supply to L1,L2 and leave L3 open. 2. Connect when the power supply has earth.
LABEL
LABEL
168.0
156.0 140.0
168.0
LOAD
LOAD
156.0 140.0
49.0
13 - 42
14 - 1
14.2 Introduction 14.2.1 Features of servo motor The following table indicates the main features of the servo motor. The items marked standard. For detailed specifications, refer to the chapter of the servo motor series.
Item Feature Rated speed Encoder resolution [pulse/rev] Rated output [kW] Power supply voltage of compatible servo amplifier (Note 1) Electromagnetic brake Special shaft Compliance with overseas standards Protection type EN Standard UL/C-UL Standard IP55 (Note 4, 5) IP65 One-phase 230VAC Three-phase 200VAC to 230VAC (Note 2) (Note 3) (Note 2) (Note 3) 2000r/min 3000r/min 131072 0.1 to 0.75 131072 0.5 to 2.0 (Note 4) Servo motor series HF-KE W1-S100 Low inertia Small capacity HF-SE JW1-S100 Medium inertia/medium capacity
are supported as
Note 1. Some power supply voltages may not be usable depending on the servo amplifier capacity. For the power supply voltage range, refer to section 1.3. 2. Compatible products are available. For details, refer to section 14.6.3 and 14.7.3. 3. Compatible products are available. For details, refer to section 14.6.4 and 14.7.4. 4. Except for the shaft-through portion. 5. Only HF-SE52JW1-S100 corresponds.
Model Input power Rated output Rated speed, Protection structure, Insulation class, Mass Serial number
INPUT 3AC 96V 0.8A OUTPUT 100W IEC60034-1 '03 3000r/min IP55CI.B 0.5kg SER.No. H14425001 034
14 - 2
14.2.3 Parts identification (1) HF-KE W1-S100 For full information of the cable connector, refer to section 13.1.2.
Power supply connector (Note) Encode cable
Encoder
Note. The servo motor with electromagnetic brake has the electromagnetic brake connector separately.
Encoder
Note. The servo motor with electromagnetic brake has the electromagnetic brake connector separately.
14 - 3
CAUTION
The electromagnetic brake is provided to prevent a drop at a power failure or servo alarm occurrence during vertical drive or to hold a shaft at a stop. Do not use it for normal braking (including braking at servo lock). The brake has a time lag. Use the brake so that servo motor control is started after the brake has completely opened. Configure the electromagnetic brake operating circuit as a double circuit so that it will also be operated by an external emergency stop (EMG). For details of the circuit configuration and timing chart, refer to section 3.5 and 3.7.
The servo motor with electromagnetic brake can be used to prevent a drop in vertical lift applications or to ensure double safety at an emergency stop, for example. When performing servo motor operation, supply power to the electromagnetic brake to release the brake. Switching power off makes the brake effective. (1) Electromagnetic brake power supply Prepare the following power supply for use with the electromagnetic brake only. The electromagnetic brake terminals (B1, B2) have no polarity.
24VDC power supply for electromagnetic brake RA Switch VAR B1 Electromagnetic 24VDC power supply for electromagnetic brake or RA Switch VAR B1 Electromagnetic
B2
B2
The surge absorber (VAR) must be installed across B1-B2. For the selection of the surge absorber, refer to section 13.2.5. (2) Sound generation Though the brake lining may rattle during operation, it poses no functional problem. If braking sound occurs, it may be improved by setting the machine resonance suppression filter or adaptive vibration suppression control in the servo amplifier parameters. For details, refer to section 8.2 and 8.3. (3) Others A leakage magnetic flux will occur at the shaft end of the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake. Note that chips, screws and other magnetic substances are attracted.
14 - 4
14.2.5 Servo motor shaft shapes In addition to the straight shaft, the keyway shaft and D cut shaft are available as the servo motor shafts. The keyway shaft and D cut shaft cannot be used in frequent start/stop applications. Since we cannot warrant the servo motor against fracture and similar accidents attributable to a loose key, use a friction coupling, etc. when coupling the shaft with a machine. The shaft shape of the standard servo motor changes depending on the series and capacity. Refer to section 14.6.4 and 14.7.4.
D cut shaft
Straight shaft
14 - 5
14.3 Installation Stacking in excess of the limited number of products is not allowed. Install the equipment to incombustibles. Installing them directly or close to combustibles will led to a fire. Install the equipment in a load-bearing place in accordance with this Instruction Manual. Do not get on or put heavy load on the equipment to prevent injury. Use the equipment within the specified environmental condition range. Refer to the specifications of the servo motor series. Do not subject the servo motor to drop impact or shock loads as they are precision equipment. Do not install or operate a faulty servo amplifier. Do not hold the cable, shaft or encoder to carry the servo motor. Otherwise, a fault or injury may occur. The lifting eyebolts of the servo motor may only be used to transport the servo motor. They must not be used to transport the servo motor when it is mounted on a machine. The servo motor with reduction gear must be installed in the specified direction. Otherwise, it can leak oil, leading to a fire or fault. Securely fix the servo motor to the machine. If fixed insecurely, the servo motor will come off during operation, leading to injury. When coupling the shaft end of the servo motor, do not subject the shaft end to impact, such as hammering. The encoder may become faulty. When coupling a load to the servo motor, do not use a rigid coupling. Doing so can cause the shaft to break. Balance the load to the extent possible. Failure to do so can cause vibration during servo motor operation or damage the bearings and encoder. Take safety measures, e.g. provide covers, to prevent accidental access to the rotating parts of the servo motor during operation. Do not subject the servo motor shaft to more than the permissible load. Otherwise, the shaft may break, leading to injury. When the product has been stored for an extended period of time, consult Mitsubishi.
CAUTION
14 - 6
14.3.1 Installation orientation (1) Standard servo motor The following table indicates the installation orientation of the standard servo motor.
Servo Motor Series HF-KE W1-S100 HF-SE JW1-S100 Direction of Installation May be installed in any direction. Remarks For installation in the horizontal direction, it is recommended to set the connector section downward.
When installing the servo motor horizontally, face the power cable and encoder cable down ward. When installing the servo motor vertically or obliquely, provide a connection and trap for the cable.
Cable trap
(2) Servo motor with electromagnetic brake The servo motor with electromagnetic brake can also be installed in the same orientation as the standard servo motor. When the servo motor with electromagnetic brake is installed with the shaft end at top, the brake plate may generate sliding sound but it is not a fault. 14.3.2 Load remove precautions POINT During assembling, the shaft end must not be hammered. Doing so can cause the encoder to fail.
(1) When mounting a pulley to the servo motor shaft provided with a keyway, use the screw hole in the shaft end. To fit the pulley, first insert a double-end stud into the screw hole of the shaft, put a washer against the end face of the coupling, and insert and tighten a nut to force the pulley in.
Servo motor Double-end stud
14 - 7
(2) For the servo motor shaft with a keyway, use the screw hole in the shaft end. For the shaft without a keyway, use a friction coupling or the like. (3) When removing the pulley, use a pulley remover to protect the shaft from hard load and or impact. (4) To ensure safety, fit a protective cover or the like on the rotary area, such as the pulley, mounted to the shaft. (5) When a threaded shaft end part is needed to mount a pulley on the shaft, please contact us. (6) The orientation of the encoder on the servo motor cannot be changed. (7) For installation of the servo motor, use spring washers, etc. and fully tighten the bolts so that they do not become loose due to vibration. 14.3.3 Permissible load for the shaft POINT Do not use a rigid coupling as it may apply excessive bending load to the shaft, leading to shaft breakage. For the permissible shaft load specific to the servo motor, refer to the chapter of the servo motor series. (1) Use a flexible coupling and make sure that the misalignment of the shaft is less than the permissible radial load. (2) When using a pulley, sprocket or timing belt, select a diameter that will fit into the permissible radial load. (3) Excess of the permissible load can cause the bearing life to reduce and the shaft to break. (4) The load indicated in this section is static load in a single direction and does not include eccentric load. Make eccentric load as small as possible. Not doing so can cause the servo motor to be damaged. 14.3.4 Protection from oil and water Avoid foreign matter, such as oil, from being inside the axis on the servo motor. When installing the servo motor, consider the items in this section.
14 - 8
(1) Do not use the servo motor with its cable soaked in oil or water. (Figure on the right)
Cover
(2) When the servo motor is to be installed with the shaft end at top, provide measures so that it is not exposed to oil and water entering from the machine side, gear box, etc.
Gear Lubricating oil
Servo motor
(3) If the servo motor is exposed to oil such as coolant, the sealant, packing, cable and others may be affected depending on the oil type. (4) In the environment where the servo motor is exposed to oil mist, oil, water, grease and/or like, the servo motor of the standard specifications may not be usable. Contact us. 14.3.5 Cable The power supply cable, brake cable and encoder cables connected to the servo motor should be fixed to the servo motor to keep them from moving. Otherwise, cable breaks may occur. In addition, do not modify the connectors, terminals and others at the ends of the cables.
14 - 9
14.3.6 Inspection Before starting maintenance and/or inspection, turn off the power and wait for 15 minutes or more until the charge lamp turns off. Otherwise, an electric shock may occur. In addition, always confirm from the front of the servo amplifier whether the charge lamp is off or not. Any person who is involved in inspection should be fully competent to do the work. Otherwise, you may get an electric shock. For repair and parts replacement, contact your safes representative. POINT Do not disassemble and/or repair the equipment on customer side. It is recommended to make the following checks periodically. (a) Check the servo motor bearings, brake section, etc. for unusual noise. (b) Check the cables and the like for scratches and cracks. Especially when the junction cable is movable, perform periodic inspection according to operating conditions. (c) Check the servo motor shaft and coupling for misalignment. (d) Check the power supply connector and encoder connector tightening screws for looseness. 14.3.7 Life The following parts must be changed periodically as listed below. If any part is found faulty, it must be changed immediately even when it has not yet reached the end of its life, which depends on the operating method and environmental conditions. For parts replacement, please contact your sales representative.
Part name Bearings Encoder Guideline of life 20,000 to 30,000 hours 20,000 to 30,000 hours Remarks The Guideline of Life field gives the reference time. If any fault is found before this time is reached, the part must be changed.
WARNING
When the servo motor is run at rated speed under rated load, change the bearings in 20,000 to 30,000 hours as a guideline. This differs on the operating conditions. The bearings must also be changed if unusual noise or vibration is found during inspection.
14 - 10
14.3.8 Machine accuracies The following table indicates the machine accuracies of the servo motor around the output shaft and mounting. (except the optional products)
Accuracy [mm] Runout of flange surface to output shaft Runout of fitting OD of flange surface Runout of output shaft end Measuring position a) b) c) Flange size Less than 0.05 0.04 0.02 100 130 0.06 0.04 0.02 176 0.08 0.06 0.03
Reference diagram
b) c)
a)
14 - 11
14.4 Connectors used for servo motor wiring 14.4.1 Selection of connectors Use the connector configuration products given in the table as the connectors for connection with the servo motor. Refer to section 14.4.2 for the compatible connector configuration products. (1) HF-KE W1-S100
Servo motor HF-KE(B)W1-S100 Wiring connector For encoder Connector configuration A For power supply Connector configuration B For brake Connector configuration C
Encoder connector
Brake connector
14 - 12
These connectors can be used for the EN Standard and UL/C-UL Standard.
Connector configuration
Configuration product Connector (IP65) Connector: 1674320-1 (Tyco Electronics) Crimping tool For Ground clip: 1596970-1 For REC. contact: 1596847 (Tyco Electronics)
Connector configuration
Configuration product Connector (IP55) Connector: JN4FT04SJ1-R HOOD SOCKET INSULATOR BUSHING GROUND NUT Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100 (A534G) (JAE) Crimping tool
CT160-3-TMH5B (JAE)
JN4AT04NJ1 (JAE)
Connector configuration
Configuration product Connector (IP55) Connector: JN4FT02SJ1-R HOOD SOCKET INSULATOR BUSHING GROUND NUT Contact: ST-TMH-S-C1B-100 (A534G) (JAE) Crimping tool
CT160-3-TMH5B (JAE)
JN4AT02PJ1 (JAE)
14 - 13
1) Plug
2) Back shell
Cable
3) Cable clamp
3) Cable clamp(DDK) Cable OD [mm] 6.8 to 10 CE-20BA-S-D Model name
Connector configuration
IP65/IP67 EN standard
CE3057-12A-3-D
D/MS3102A20-29P
Cable
Connector configuration
2) Cable clamp(DDK) Application General environment (Note) 1) Plug (DDK) Cable OD [mm] 15.9 (Bushing ID) Model name
Straight Angle
D/MS3106B20-29S D/MS3108B20-29S
D/MS3057-12A
D/MS3102A20-29P
14 - 14
Cable
1) Plug (DDK) Connector configuration Application Type Model name CE05-6A18-10SD-D-BSS Applicable wire size: AWG14 to 12 CE05-8A18-10SD-D-BAS Applicable wire size: AWG14 to 12 D/MS3106B18-10S Applicable wire size: AWG14 to 12 D/MS3108B18-10S Applicable wire size: AWG14 to 12
2) Cable Clamp (DDK) Cable OD [mm] (Reference) 8.5 to 11 10.5 to 14.1 8.5 to 11 10.5 to 14.1 14.3 (Bushing ID) 14.3 (Bushing ID) Model name CE3057-10A-2-D CE3057-10A-1-D CE3057-10A-2-D CE3057-10A-1-D D/MS3057-10A D/MS3057-10A D/MS3102A18-10P Servo motor power supply connector
Straight plug
Plug (DDK) Connector configuration Application Type Straight plug CM10-SP2S-S CM10-SP2S-M CM10-SP2S-L G IP65 IP67 Straight CM10-SP2S-S CM10-SP2S-M CM10-SP2S-L Socket contact CM10-#22SC(S2)-100 CM10-#22SC(S2)-100 CM10-#22SC(S2)-100 CM10-#22SC(C3)-100 CM10-#22SC(C3)-100 CM10-#22SC(C3)-100 Contact shape Soldering type Applicable wire size: AWG16 or less Crimping type Applicable wire size: AWG20 to 16 Connection tool (357J-50448) is necessary. Cable OD [mm] (Reference) 4.0 to 6.0 6.0 to 9.0 9.0 to 11.6 4.0 to 6.0 6.0 to 9.0 9.0 to 11.6
CM10-R2P
14 - 15
Cable
Connector configuration
1) Plug (DDK) Application Type Straight Angle Straight Angle Model name CE05-6A22-22SD-D-BSS Applicable wire size: AWG12 to 8 CE05-8A22-22SD-D-BAS Applicable wire size: AWG12 to 8 D/MS3106B22-22S Applicable wire size: AWG12 to 8 D/MS3108B22-22S Applicable wire size: AWG12 to 8
2) Cable clamp (DDK) Cable OD [mm] (Reference) 9.5 to 13 12.5 to 16 9.5 to 13 12.5 to 16 15.9 (Bushing ID) 15.9 (Bushing ID) Model name CD3057-12A-2-D CD3057-12A-1-D CD3057-12A-2-D CD3057-12A-1-D D/MS3057-12A D/MS3057-12A
D/MS3102A22-22P
14 - 16
14.5 Connector outline drawings The connector outline drawings for wiring the servo motor are shown below. (1) Tyco Electronics
Model Housing Connector pin Crimping tool 14 : 1-172161-9 : 170359-1 170363-1 (loose piece) : 755330-1 23.7 [Unit: mm]
14
4.2
4.2
(2) Molex
[Unit: mm]
Circuit number 1 2 3 4
Model 5509-04P-210 5559-06P-210 Number of poles 4 6 A 4.2 8.4 B 9.6 13.8
5559
11.6
16
8
4.6
11.9
13
5 1 1
4.2
(Pitch) 4.2 A B
2.7
9.6
4 poles
6 poles
14 - 17
J
Model D/MS3106B18-10S D/MS3106B20-29S D/MS3106B22-22S A J L Q V 1-20UNEF
[Unit: mm]
W 9.53 Y 42 47 50
Y or less
1 1/4-18UNEF 18.26 55.57 37.28 1 3/16-18UNEF 9.53 1 3/8-18UNEF 18.26 56.57 40.48 1 3/16-18UNEF 9.53
L or less
[Unit: mm]
A
Q
Model A J L Q R U 30.2 V 1-20UNEF W 9.53
D/MS3108B18-10S 1 1/8-18UNEF 18.26 68.27 34.13 20.5 D/MS3108B20-29S 1 1/4-18UNEF 18.26 76.98 37.28 22.5 D/MS3108B22-22S 1 3/8-18UNEF 18.26 76.98 40.48 24.1
W or more
14 - 18
0.8
A 1 1/8-18UNEF-2B 1 3/8-18UNEF-2B
B 34.13 40.48
C 32.1 38.3
D 57 61
W 1-20UNEF-2A 1 3/16-18UNEF-2A
[Unit: mm]
D or less A
0.7
Y or more
(S)
0.7
Model name
CE05-8A18-10SD-D-BAS CE05-8A22-22SD-D-BAS
A
1 1/8-18UNEF-2B 1 3/8-18UNEF-2B
B
34.13 40.48
D
69.5 75.5
W
1-20UNEF-2A 1 3/16-18UNEF-2A
0 0.38
R
13.2 16.3
U
30.2 33.3
(S)
43.4 49.6
Y
7.5 7.5
14 - 19
D H or less
E C
Model
D/MS3106A20-29S(D190)
A
1 1/4-18UNEF-2B
B
37.28 (1.47)
C
34.11 (1.34)
D
1 1/8-18UNEF-2A
E
12.16 (0.48)
G
26.8 (1.06)
J
18.26 (0.72)
#12
8 or less
#8
10 or less
#4
13 or less
#0
13 or less
CM10-SP2S-S/M/L
[Unit: mm]
21
18.9 or
less
For CM10-SP2S-S/M/L
51.4
<Back shell>
CE02-20BS-S-D
35 10.9 1 1/8-18UNEF-2B O ring
35
19
CE-20BA-S
15
CL
48.3
7.85 or more
1 3/16-18UNEF-2A
14 - 20
7.5 or more
33.3
36
1 1/8-18UNEF-2B O ring
17.8
<Cable clamp>
[Unit: mm]
Effective thread length C 1.6
0.7
0.7
E (Bushing ID)
0.7
F (Movable range)
A 23.8 23.8
B 30.1 35.0
C 10.3 10.3
D 15.9 19.0
E 14.3 15.9
F 3.2 4.0
G 31.7 37.3
V 1-20UNEF 1 3/16-18UNEF-2A
[Unit: mm]
(D) Effective thread length C 1.6 (0.063) V Thread
0.7
0.7
0.7
Shell size
F 14.1
18
23.8
30.1
10.3
41.3
31.7
3.2
1-20UNEF2B
22
23.8
35
10.3
41.3
19 13.0
37.3
4.0
1 3/1618UNEF-2B 1 3/1618UNEF-2B
20
23.8
35
10.3
41.3
19
10.0
37.3
4.0
14 - 21
14.6 HF-KE W1-S100 This chapter provides information on the servo motor specifications and characteristics. When using the HF-KE W1-S100 servo motor, always read the Safety Instructions in the beginning of this manual and section 14.1 to 14.4, in addition to this section. 14.6.1 Model name make up
HF-KE
Series name
W1- S100
MR-E super servo motor Encoder resolution 131072 [pulse/rev] Shaft type (Special shaft) Symbol None Shaft shape Standard (Straight shaft) HF-KE W1-S100 13 to 73 Appearance
(Note 1) (Note 2) With keyway 23 to 73 K (Note 1) D-cut shaft 13 D Note 1. The special shaft applies to the standard servo motor and servo motor with electromagnetic brake. 2. With key. Electromagnetic brake Symbol Electromagnetic brake None B Rated speed 3000 [r/min] Rated output Symbol 1 2 3 4 Rated output [W] 100 200 400 750 Without With
14 - 22
15 times or less (Note 4) (Note 4) (Note 4) (Note 4) (Note 4) 249 747 2490 140 210 700 2100
Refer to section 12.2. 0.8 1.4 2.7 5.2 2.4 4.2 8.1 15.6 Incremental encoder (Resolution per servo motor 1 rotation: 131072 pulse/rev) Class B Totally - enclosed, self-cooled (protection type: IP55 (Note 5) 0 to 40 (non-freezing) 32 to 104 (non-freezing) 15 to 70 (non-freezing) 5 to 158 (non-freezing) 80 RH or less (non-condensing) 90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt. Max. 1000m above sea level X, Y: 49 25 88 20 59 13 0.56 1.24 V-10 30 245 55 98 22 0.94 2.07 1.5 3.31 40 392 88 147 33 2.9 6.39
Note 1. The rated output and rated speed of the servo motor assume that the rated power supply voltage and frequency are as indicated in section 1.3. 2. If the load inertia moment ratio exceeds the indicated value, please consult us. 3. Refer to the outline dimension drawing for the servo motors with electromagnetic brake. 4. When the effective torque is within the rated torque range, there are no restrictions on the regenerative brake duty. Note that the recommended load inertia moment ratio is 15 times or less. 5. Except for the shaft-through portion.
14 - 23
6. In the environment where the servo motor is exposed to oil mist, oil and/or water, the servo motor of the standard specifications may not be usable. Contact us. 7. The vibration direction is as shown in the figure. The value is the one at the part that indicates the maximum value (normally the opposite-to-load side bracket). When the servo motor stops, fretting is likely to occur at the bearing. Therefore, suppress the vibration to about half of the permissible value.
Vibration amplitude (both amplitudes) Servo motor
1000
100
[ m] 10 Vibration
Speed[r/min]
8. V-10 indicates that the amplitude of a single servo motor is 10 m or less. The following figure shows the servo motor installation position for measurement and the measuring position.
Servo motor
Top
Bottom
Measuring position
9. For the symbols in the table, refer to the following diagram: Do not subject the shaft to load greater than this value. The values in the table assume that the loads work singly.
L Radial load L: Distance from flange mounting surface to load center Thrust load
HF-KE23W1-S100
2.5
HF-KE43W1-S100
4.5 4
HF-KE73W1-S100
8 7
Torque[N m]
Torque[N m]
0.8
Torque[N m]
Torque[N m]
Short-duration
3.5
6 5 4 3 2
0.6
1.5
Short-duration
3 2.5 2 1.5
Short-duration
Short-duration
0.4
0.2
0.5
0.5 0 0
1 0 0
Speed[r/min]
Speed[r/min]
Speed[r/min]
Speed[r/min]
14 - 24
14.6.3 Electromagnetic brake characteristics The electromagnetic brake is provided to prevent a drop at a power failure or servo alarm occurrence during vertical drive or to hold a shaft at a stop. Do not use it for normal braking (including braking at servo lock).
CAUTION
The characteristics of the electromagnetic brake provided for the servo motor with electromagnetic brake are indicated below.
Servo motor Item Type (Note 1) Rated voltage (Note 4) Capacity Static friction torque Release delay time (Note 2) Braking delay time (Note 2) [s] DC off Per braking Per hour Number of braking cycles [times] Work per braking [J] [J] [J] [W] at 20 (68 ) [N m] [oz in] [s] 6.3 0.32 45.3 0.03 0.01 5.6 56 2.5 20000 5.6 13 HF-KE BW1-S100 23 Spring-loaded safety brake 0 24V 10% DC 7.9 1.3 184.2 0.03 0.02 22 220 1.2 20000 22 10 2.4 340 0.04 0.02 64 640 0.9 20000 64 43 73
Brake looseness at servo motor shaft (Note 5) [degrees] Brake life (Note 3)
Note 1. There is no manual release mechanism. When it is necessary to hand-turn the servo motor shaft for machine centering, etc., use a separate 24VDC power supply to release the brake electrically. 2. The value for initial ON gap at 20 (68 ). 3. The brake gap will increase as the brake lining wears, but the gap is not adjustable. The brake life indicated is the number of braking cycles after which adjustment will be required. 4. Always prepare a power supply exclusively used for the electromagnetic brake. 5. The above values are typical initial values and not guaranteed values.
14 - 25
14.6.4 Servo motors with special shafts The servo motors with special shafts indicated by the symbols (K D) in the table are available. K and D are the symbols attached to the servo motor model names.
Servo motor HF-KE13W1-S100 HF-KE23W1-S100 to HF-KE73W1-S100 K Shaft shape Keyway shaft (with key) D cut shaft D
[Unit: mm]
Y M4 Depth 15 M5 Depth 20
Section A-A
14 - 26
1 8h6
14.6.5 Outline dimension drawings The dimensions without tolerances are reference dimensions. (1) Standard (Without electromagnetic brake, without reduction gear)
Model HF-KE13W1-S100 Output [W] 100 Inertia moment J[ 10 4 kg m2] (WK2[oz in2]) 0.088 (0.48) Mass [kg]([Ib]) 0.56 (1.24)
[Unit: mm]
20.5 Motor plate
Bottom
20.7
82.4 Motor plate Caution plate for high temperature (Opposite side)
25 2.5 21.5
40
45
Caution plate
46
TUV plate Encoder connector 13.7 27.4 4.9 10.1 11.7 11.7 21.5 9.5 19.2 40.5 1 2 3
7
13.9 27.5
6.4
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
Opposite-to-load side
Encoder connector
11.7 21.5
11.7 19.2
9.5
BC30561A
14 - 27
Model HF-KE23W1-S100
[Unit: mm]
76.6 Caution plate for Motor plate high temperature (Opposite siede) 30 7 3 4- 5.8 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw 60
45
70
Caution plate
Top
Top
Top
Encoder connector 13.7 10 10.1 11.8 9.5 39.3 11.7 19.2 Power supply connector Power supply connector pin connection list Power supply connector Encoder connector 9.5 11.8 21.5 11.7 19.2
9
7
1 2 3 4
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
BC30560A
Model HF-KE43W1-S100
[Unit: mm]
98.5 Caution plate for high temperature Motor plate (Opposite side) 7 3 30 4- 5.8 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw 60
45
70
Top Bottom
Caution plate
Top Top
Top
Encoder connector 13.7 10 10.1 11.8 9.5 61.2 Power supply connector Power supply connector pin connection list Power supply connector Encoder connector 9.5 11.8 21.5 11.7 19.2
9
11.7
19.2
1 2 3 4
7
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
BC30559A
14 - 28
Model HF-KE73W1-S100
[Unit: mm]
113.8 Caution plate for high temperature Motor plate (Opposite side) 8 3 40
45
90
Bottom
Top Bottom
Caution plate
Top
Encoder connector 13.7 27.4 11.8 11.7 11.5 9.9 9.5 19.2 72.3 Power supply connector Opposite-to-load side
7
14
12
27.8 Power supply connector pin connection list 1 2 3 Encoder connector 11.8 21.4 11.7
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
BC30557A
14 - 29
[Unit: mm]
20.5 Motor plate Caution plate 20.7 123.5 Caution plate for high temperature 40
45
46
Top
Top
Encoder connector 10.1 11.7 13.7 27.4 4.9 11.7 21.5 58.3 Brake connector 18.4 9.5 19.2 40.5
TUV plate Power supply connector 13.9 Brake connector pin connection list 1
7
6.4
2
9
Pin No. 1 2
Application B1 B2
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
13
Opposite-to-load side
Encoder connector
11.7 21.5
9.5
BC30652*
14 - 30
Model HF-KE23BW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
116.1 Caution plate for Motor plate high temperature (Opposite side) 30 7 3 4- 5.8 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw 60
45
Caution plate
70
Top
21.5 57.8
9.5 19.2
Power supply connector 39.3 Brake connector pin connection list 1 2 1 2 3 4 13.9 27.8 5.9
Brake connector
13.5
Pin No. 1 2
Application B1 B2
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
Opposite-to-load side
Power supply connector Encoder connector 11.8 11.7 21.5 18.3 57.8 9.5 Brake connector
BC30653*
14 - 31
Model HF-KE43BW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
138 Caution plate for high temperature Motor plate (Opposite side) 30 7 3 60
45
70
Caution plate
Encoder connector 10.1 13.7 10 28.4 11.8 11.7 21.5 57.8 9.5 19.2 Power supply connector 13.9 61.2 Brake connector Brake connector pin connection list 1 2 1 2 3 4 27.8 5.9
Pin No. 1 2
Application B1 B2
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
13.5
Opposite-to-load side
Power supply connector Encoder connector 11.8 11.7 21.5 18.3 57.8 9.5 Brake connector
BC30654*
14 - 32
Model HF-KE73BW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
157 Motor plate (Opposite side) Caution plate for high temperature TUV plate Motor plate
Bottom Top Bottom Bottom Bottom Top Top
40 8 3
45
80
90
Caution plate
Top
14 12 27.8 Brake connector pin connection list Power supply connector pin connection list
Pin No. 1 2
Application B1 B2
Opposite-to-load side
Pin No. 1 2 3 4
Application (Earth) U V W
BC30655*
14 - 33
14.7 HF-SE JW1-S100 This chapter provides information on the servo motor specifications and characteristics. When using the HFSE JW1-S100 servo motor, always read the Safety Instructions in the beginning of this manual and section 14.1 to 14.4, in addition to this section. 14.7.1 Model name make up
HF-SE
Series name
J W1- S100
MR-E super servo motor Encoder resolution 131072 [pulse/rev] Oil seal Shaft type (Special shaft) Symbol None Shaft shape Standard (Straight shaft) Appearance
(Note 1) (Note 2) With keyway K Note 1. The special shaft applies to the standard servo motor and servo motor with electromagnetic brake. 2. Without key. Electromagnetic brake Symbol Electromagnetic brake None B Rated speed 2000[r/min] Rated output Symbol 5 10 15 20 Rated output [W] 500 1000 1500 2000 Without With
14 - 34
760 355 Refer to section 12.2. 2.9 5.3 8.0 10 8.7 15.9 24 30 Incremental encoder (resolution: 131072pulse/rev) Oil seal Class F Totally - enclosed, self-cooled(protection type: IP65 (Note 4)) 0 to 40 (non-freezing) 32 to 104 (non-freezing) 15 to 70 (non-freezing) 5 to 158 (non-freezing) 80 RH or less (non-condensing) 90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt. Max. 1000m above sea level X, Y: 24.5 V-10 55 980 220 490 110 6.5 14.3 X: 24.5 Y: 49 79 2058 463 980 220 12 26.5
4.8 10.6
8.3 18.3
Note 1. The rated output and rated speed of the servo motor assume that the rated power supply voltage and frequency are as indicated in section 1.3. 2. If the load inertia moment ratio exceeds the indicated value, please consult us. 3. Refer to the outline dimension drawing for the servo motor with electromagnetic brake.
14 - 35
Servo motor
1000
100
[ m]
Vibration
10
Speed[r/min]
6. V-10 indicates that the amplitude of a single servo motor is 10 m or less. The following figure shows the servo motor installation position for measurement and the measuring position.
Servo motor
Top
Bottom
Measuring position
7. For the symbols in the table, refer to the following diagram: Do not subject the shaft to load greater than this value. The values in the table assume that the loads work singly.
L Radial load L: Distance from flange mounting surface to load center Thrust load
HF-SE102JW1-S100
15
HF-SE152JW1-S100
25
HF-SE202JW1-S100
30
20
Torque[N m]
Torque[N m]
Torque[N m]
Torque[N m]
10
15
20
10
10
Rotational speed[r/min]
Rotational speed[r/min]
Rotational speed[r/min]
Rotational speed[r/min]
14 - 36
14.7.3 Electromagnetic brake characteristics The electromagnetic brake is provided to prevent a drop at a power failure or servo alarm occurrence during vertical drive or to hold a shaft at a stop. Do not use it for normal braking (including braking at servo lock).
CAUTION
The characteristics of the electromagnetic brake provided for the servo motor with electromagnetic brake are indicated below.
Servo motor Item Type (Note 1) Rated voltage (Note 4) Capacity Static friction torque Release delay time (Note 2) Braking delay time (Note 2) [s] DC off Per braking Per hour Number of braking cycles[times] Work per braking [J] [J] [J] [degrees] [W] at 20 (68 ) [N m] [oz in] [s] 19 8.3 1175 0.04 0.03 400 4000 0.2 to 0.6 20000 200 52 to 152 Spring-loaded safety brake 0 24V 10% DC 34 44 6231 0.1 0.03 4500 45000 0.2 to 0.6 20000 1000 HF-SE BJW1-S100 202
Note 1. There is no manual release mechanism. When it is necessary to hand-turn the servo motor shaft for machine centering, etc., use a separate 24VDC power supply to release the brake electrically. 2. The value for initial ON gap at 20 (68 ). 3. The brake gap will increase as the brake lining wears, but the gap is not adjustable. The brake life indicated is the number of braking cycles after which adjustment will be required. 4. Always prepare a power supply exclusively used for the electromagnetic brake. 5. The above values are typical initial values and not guaranteed values.
14 - 37
14.7.4 Servo motors with special shafts The servo motors with special shafts indicated by the symbol (K) in the table is available. K is the symbols attached to the servo motor model names.
Servo motor HF-SE52JW1-S100 to HF-SE202JW1-S100 Shaft shape Keyway shaft (without key) K
R Q QK A W S QL U
[Unit: mm] Y
0 0.036
36
0.2 0
M8 Depth 20 M8 Depth 20
HC-SE202KJW1-S100 35
79
75
10
0 0.036
55
0.2 0
Y Section A-A
14 - 38
14.7.5 Outline dimension drawings The values in yards/pounds are reference values. (1) Standard (Without electromagnetic brake, without reduction gear)
Model HF-SE52JW1-S100 Output [kW] 0.5 Inertia moment 2 2 2 J[ 10 4 kg m ] (WK [oz in ]) 6.1 (33.4) Mass [kg] ([Ib]) 4.8 (11.7)
[Unit: mm]
120 Caution plate Motor plate Logo plate Caution plate Caution plate 39.7 Motor plate (Opposite side) 12 55 50 3 130
45
Top
Bottom Top
Top
14 5
16 5
Oil seal .. TUV plate W 19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P Power supply connector MS3102A18-10P
C B D A
Earth
20.9 57.8
13.5 58
BC30563A
Mass [kg] ([Ib]) 6.5 (15.4)
Model HF-SE102JW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
142 Motor plate Logo plate Caution plate Caution plate 39.7 Motor plate (Opposite side) Caution plate 12 55 50 3 130
45
Bottom
Top
Bottom Top
14 5
16 5
Oil seal
.. TUV plate 19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P Power supply connector MS3102A18-10P
W
C B D A
Earth
20.9 79.8
13.5 58
BC30566A
14 - 39
Model HF-SE152JW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
Motor plate Logo plate Caution plate 39.7 Caution plate Caution plate 164 Motor plate (Opposite side) 12 55 50 3 130
45
Bottom
Top
14 5
16 5
Oil seal
.. TUV plate 19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P Power supply connector MS3102A18-10P 20.9 101.8
W
C B D A
Earth
13.5 58
BC30565A
Mass [kg] ([Ib]) 12 (27.6)
Model HF-SE202JW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
145 Logo plate Motor plate Caution plate Caution plate
Bottom Top Bottom Top
0 0.025
79 18 3 75
176
45
Caution plate
40
23 0
0.010 0
0 20
Bottom Top
Bottom Top
Top
.. TUV plate
81.5
114.3
Bottom
35
19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P 24.8 Power supply connector MS3102A22-22P 79.8
Oil seal W
C B D A
Earth
U 82
140.9
BC30564B
14 - 40
[Unit: mm]
4154.5 Motor plate Caution plate (Opposite side) 45 Caution plate 55 50 12 3 9 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw. 130
45
Bottom Bottom Top Top Bottom Top Bottom Top Bottom Top Bottom Top
14
16 5
.. TUV plate
Oil seal
Earth 13.5 58 U 29
BC30648*
Mass [kg] ([Ib]) 8.5 (19.8)
Model HF-SE102BJW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
4- 9 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw. Logo plate Motor plate Caution plate 45 Caution plate 176.5 Caution plate Motor plate (Opposite side) 3 55 50 12 130
45
Bottom Top Bottom Bottom Top Bottom Top Bottom Top Bottom Top
Top
14 5
16 5
.. TUV plate
19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P 60.5 20.9 79.8 W Brake connector CM10-R2P Power supply connector MS3102A18-10P
29 58
BC30649*
14 - 41
Model HF-SE152BJW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
4- 9 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw. Logo plate Motor plate Caution plate 45 Caution plate 198.5 Caution plate Motor plate (Opposite side) 55 50 12 3
45
130
Bottom Top
Top
Top
14 5
Bottom Top
16
19.5 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P Brake connector CM10-R2P Power supply connector MS3102A18-10P
20.9 101.8
V
C B D A
58 U
BC30650*
Mass [kg] ([Ib]) 18 (40.8)
Model HF-SE202BJW1-S100
[Unit: mm]
4- 13.5 mounting hole Use hexagon socket head cap screw. 194.5 Motor plate Logo plate 47 Caution plate Caution plate Motor plate (Opposite side) Caution plate 18 3
45
79
176
75
23 0
Bottom Top Bottom Top Top Bottom Top Bottom Top
20
Bottom
Bottom Top
19.5 68 Encoder connector MS3102A20-29P Brake connector .. CM10-R2P TUV plate 44 Brake Brake connector layout Motor flange direction Power supply connector MS3102A22-22P
Oil seal W
C B D A
Earth
24.8 79.8
82
BC30651*
14 - 42
(1) Speed control mode An external analog speed command (0 to 10VDC) or parameter-driven internal speed command (max. 7 speeds) is used to control the speed and direction of a servo motor smoothly. There are also the acceleration/deceleration time constant setting in response to speed command, the servo lock function at a stop time, and automatic offset adjustment function in response to external analog speed command. (2) Torque control mode An external analog torque command (0 to 8VDC) or parameter-driven internal torque command is used to control the torque output by the servo motor. To prevent unexpected operation under no load, the speed limit function (external or internal setting) is also available for application to tension control and the like.
15 - 1
D (Note 1)
Diode stack
Relay
Dynamic brake RA
24VDC B1
B2 (Note 3) CN2
Electromagnetic brake
Detector
Virtual encoder
D/A
Analog (2 channels)
Note 1. The built-in regenerative resistor is not provided for the MR-E-10AG-QW003/MR-E-20AG-QW003. 2. Single-phase 230VAC power supply can be used for MR-E-70AG-QW003 or servo amplifiers with smaller capacities. Connect the power cables to L1 and L2 while leaving L3 open. Refer to section 15.1.3 for the power supply specification. 3. The control circuit connectors (CN1, CN2 and CN3) are safely isolated from main circuit terminals (L1, L2, L3, U, V, W, P, C and D). 4. Servo amplifiers MR-E-200AG-QW003 have a cooling fan.
15 - 2
0.2
or less (load fluctuation 0 to 100 ) 0 (power fluctuation 10 ) or less (ambient temperature 25 10 (77 when using analog speed command
50 )),
Torque limit Torque control mode Structure [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] Analog torque command input Speed limit
10VDC/maximum torque)
8VDC/Maximum torque (input impedance 10 to 12k ) 10VDC/Rated speed) Forcecooling, open (IP00)
Set by parameter setting or external analog input (0 to Self-cooled, open (IP00) 0 to 32 to 20 to 4 to 55 (non-freezing) 131 (non-freezing) 65 (non-freezing) 149 (non-freezing)
90 RH or less (non-condensing) Indoors (no direct sunlight) Free from corrosive gas, flammable gas, oil mist, dust and dirt Max. 1000m above sea level 5.9 [m/s2] or less [kg] [lb] 0.7 1.54 0.7 1.54 1.1 2.43 1.7 3.75 1.7 3.75 2.0 4.41
15 - 3
AG - QW003
MR-E super servo amplifier (Source I/O interface) Analog input interface
MR-E-40AG-QW003 or less
MR-E-70AG-QW003, MR-E-100AG-QW003
MR-E-200AG-QW003
Rated output Symbol Rated output [W] Symbol Rated output [W] 10 100 70 750 20 200 100 1000 40 400 200 2000 Rating plate Rating plate
Rating plate
MODE
UP
DOWN
MODE CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-
SET
Used to change the display or data in each mode. Used to change the mode. Communication connector (CN3) Used to connect a command device (RS-232C) and output analog monitor data. Section 3.3 Section 13.1.2 Chapter 14 Section 3.3 Section 3.3 Section1 3.1.2
CN1
CN2 CNP2
WV U
CHARGE
I/O signal connector (CN1) Used to connect digital I/O signals. Encoder connector (CN2) Connector for connection of the servo motor encoder. Charge lamp Lit to indicate that the main circuit is charged. While this lamp is lit, do not reconnect the cables. Servo motor power connector (CNP2) Used to connect the servo motor.
CNP1
L3L2L1 D C P
Power supply/regenerative connector (CNP1) Section 3.7 Used to connect the input power supply and regenerative Section 11.1 option. Section 13.1.1 Protective earth (PE) terminal ( Fixed part (MR-E-10AG-QW003 to MR-E-40AG-QW003: 2 places Ground terminal. MR-E-70AG-QW003 MR-E-100AG-QW003: 3 places) ) Section 3.10 Section 11.1
15 - 4
(2) MR-E-200AG-QW003
Name/application Display The 5-digit, seven-segment LED shows the servo status and alarm number. Operation section Used to perform status display, diagnostic, alarm and parameter setting operations. Reference Section 15.5
MODE
UP
DOWN
SET Used to set data. Used to change the display or data in each mode. Used to change the mode. Section 15.5
Communication connector (CN3) Used to connect a command device (RS-232C) and output analog monitor data. I/O signal connector (CN1) Used to connect digital I/O signals. Rating plate Encoder connector (CN2) Connector for connection of the servo motor encoder. Power supply/regenerative connector (CNP1) Used to connect the input power supply and regenerative option. Charge lamp Lit to indicate that the main circuit is charged. While this lamp is lit, do not reconnect the cables. Protective earth (PE) terminal ( Ground terminal. )
Section 3.3 Section 13.1.2 Chapter 14 Section 15.2 Section 1.5 Section 3.3 Section 13.1.2 Section 3.7 Section 11.1 Section 13.1.1
Servo motor power connector (CNP2) Used to connect the servo motor.
15 - 5
15.1.6 Servo system with auxiliary equipment To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box.
WARNING
MODE CN3
SET
To CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-E-
To CN1
CN1
Command device
W V U
To CN2
CN2 CNP2
CNP1
Protective earth
Note. A 1-phase 230VAC power supply may be used with the servo amplifier of MR-E-70AG-QW003 or less. Connect the power supply to L1 and L2 terminals and leave L3 open. Refer to section 15.1.3 for the power supply specification.
L3 L2 L1 D C P
CHARGE
To CNP2
15 - 6
(2) MR-E-200AG-QW003
3-phase 200V to 230VAC power supply Options and auxiliary equipment Circuit breaker Magnetic contactor MR Configurator (Servo configuration software) Circuit breaker (NFB) or fuse Reference Section 13.2.2 Section 13.2.2 Section 13.1.4 Options and auxiliary equipment Regenerative option Cables Power factor improving reactor Reference Section 13.1.1 Section 13.2.1 Section 13.2.3
Servo amplifier
Personal computer
MODE
MTSUBI HI I S EZMot n o i
SET
To CN3
CN3
D C P L3 L2 L1
To CN1
CN1 CNP1
Command device
To CN2
CN2
CHARGE
L1
L2
W V U
To CNP2
CNP2
L3
P C Regenerative option
15 - 7
15.2. Signals and wiring 15.2.1 Standard connection example (1) Speed control mode
Servo amplifier (Note 7) CN1 1 9 12 10m or less (Note 7) CN1 (Note 3, 4) Emergency stop Servo-on Forward rotation start Reverse rotation start (Note 4) Forward rotation stroke end Reverse rotation stroke end EMG SON ST1 ST2 LSP LSN VIN 8 4 3 5 6 7 1 10 11 13 19 20 15 16 17 18 14 21 Plate VIN ALM ZSP SA RD SG LZ LZR LA LAR LB LBR LG OP SD Encoder Z-phase pulse (differential line driver) Encoder A-phase pulse (differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (differential line driver) Control common (Note 7) CN1 VC 0 to 10V LG TLA SD 2m or less 26 14 2 Plate (Note 7) CN3 4 3 6 (Note 8) MR Configurator (Servo configuration software) Personal computer (Note 7) CN3 Plate MO1 LG MO2 SD 2m or less A A 10k 10k (Note 6) Monitor output Max. 1mA Reading in both directions Encoder Z-phase pulse (open collector) (Note 2) RA1 RA2 Speed reached RA3 Ready RA4 Trouble (Note 5) Zero speed (Note 9) External power supply 24VDC
Analog speed command 10V/rated speed Analog torque limit 10V/max. torque
10 to
10V
(Note 1)
15 - 8
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) and forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. Use MRZJW3-SETUP 154E or 154C. 9. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
15 - 9
(Note 1)
Note 1. To prevent an electric shock, always connect the protective earth (PE) terminal (terminal marked ) of the servo amplifier to the protective earth (PE) of the control box. 2. Connect the diode in the correct direction. If it is connected reversely, the servo amplifier will be faulty and will not output signals, disabling the emergency stop and other protective circuits. 3. The emergency stop switch (normally closed contact) must be installed. 4. When starting operation, always connect the emergency stop (EMG) with VIN. (Normally closed contacts) 5. Trouble (ALM) is connected with VIN in normal alarm-free condition. 6. When connecting the personal computer together with monitor outputs 1, 2, use the branch cable (MR-E3CBL15-P). (Refer to section 13.1.3) 7. The pins with the same signal name are connected in the servo amplifier. 8. Use MRZJW3-SETUP 154E or 154C. 9. Externally supply 24VDC 10 , 200mA power for the interface. 200mA is a value applicable when all I/O signals are used. Reducing the number of I/O points decreases the current capacity. Refer to the current necessary for the interface described in section 3.6.2. Connect the external 24VDC power supply if the output signals are not used.
15 - 10
15.2.2 Internal connection diagram of servo amplifier The following is the internal connection diagram where the signal assignment has been made in the initial status in each control mode.
Servo amplifier (Note) S VIN External power supply 24VDC ST2 SON ST1 T VIN RS1 SON RS2 CN1 1 5 4 3 8 6 7 SG SD 13 Case
Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k Approx. 4.7k
14 CN3 4 6 2 1 3 Case PE
15 - 11
15.2.3 Connectors and signal arrangements POINT The pin configurations of the connectors are as viewed from the cable connector wiring section. Refer to the next page for CN1 signal assignment. (1) Signal arrangement
5 3
LG
1
RXD
MODE CN3
MITSUBISHI MR-E
SET
6
MO2
4
MO1
2
TXD
CN1
CN2 CNP2
WV U
1
P5
3
MR
7
MD
CNP1
The connector frames are connected with the earth (PE) terminal ( ) inside the servo amplifier. CN1(Speed control mode) 1 2 TLA 4 SON 6 LSP 8 EMG 10 SA 12 ZSP VIN 3 ST1 5 ST2 7 LSN 9 ALM 11 RD 13 SG 25 26 VC 15 LA 17 LB 19 LZ 21 OP 23 24 12 ZSP 14 LG 16 LAR 18 LBR 20 LZR 22 8 EMG 10 9 2 TC 4 SON 6
CN1(Torque control mode) 1 VIN 3 RS2 5 RS1 7 15 LA 17 LB 19 LZ 21 OP 23 24 25 26 VLA 14 LG 16 LAR 18 LBR 20 LZR 22
ALM 11 RD 13 SG
15 - 12
L3L2L1 D C P
MRR
MDR
CHARGE
10
LG
(2) CN1 signal assignment The signal assignment of connector changes with the control mode as indicated below. For the pins which are given parameter No.s in the related parameter column, their signals can be changed using those parameters.
Connector Pin No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 CN1 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 I VC VC/VLA VLA Note 1. I: Input signal, O: Output signal 2. S: Speed control mode, T: Torque control mode, S/T: Speed/torque control switching mode O O O O O O O I I I I I I I O O O O (Note 1) I/O (Note 2) I/O Signals in control modes S VIN TLA ST1 SON ST2 LSP LSN EMG ALM SA RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP S/T VIN TLA/TC ST1/RS2 SON LOP LSP/ LSN/ EMG ALM SA/ RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP RD ZSP SG LG LA LAR LB LBR LZ LZR OP EMG ALM No.49 No.49 No.49 No.1, 49 T VIN TC RS2 SON RS1 No.43 to 48 No.43 to 48 No.43 to 48 No.43 No.43 48 48 Related parameter
15 - 13
15.2.4 Signal explanations For the I/O interfaces (symbols in I/O column in the table), refer to section 3.6.2. In the control mode field of the table S: speed control mode, T: Torque control mode : Denotes that the signal may be used in the initial setting status. : Denotes that the signal may be used by setting the corresponding parameter among parameters 43 to 49. The pin No.s in the connector pin No. column are those in the initial status. (1) Input signals POINT The acceptance delay time of each input signal is less than 10ms.
Control mode S T
Symbol LSP
Functions/Applications To start operation, short LSP-VIN and/or LSN-VIN. Open them to bring the motor to a sudden stop and make it servo-locked. Set " 1" in parameter No.22 to make a slow stop. (Refer to section 5.2.3.) (Note) Input signals LSP 1 0 LSN 1 1 0 0 Operation CCW direction CW direction
LSN
CN1-7
1 0
Note. 0: LSP/LSN-VIN off (open) 1: SP/LSN-VIN on (short) Set parameter No.41 as indicated below to switch on the signals (keep terminals connected) automatically in the servo amplifier. Parameter No.41 1 1 Outside torque limit selection TL Automatic ON LSP LSN DI-1
Turn TL off to make Internal torque limit 1 (parameter No.28) valid, or turn it on to make Analog torque limit (TLA) valid. When using this signal, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. For details, refer to, section 15.2.5 (1)(C). When using this signal, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. (Refer to, section 3.4.1 (5).)
TL1
DI-1
15 - 14
Symbol ST1
Functions/applications Used to start the servo motor in any of the following directions. (Note) Input signals ST2 0 ST1 0 1 0 1 Servo motor starting direction Stop (servo lock) CCW CW Stop (servo lock)
Control mode P S
ST2
CN1-5
0 1 1
Note. 0: ST1/ST2-VIN off (open) 1: ST1/ST2-VIN on (short) If both ST1 and ST2 are switched on or off during operation, the servo motor will be decelerated to a stop according to the parameter No.12 setting and servo-locked. Forward rotation selection RS1 CN1-5 Used to select any of the following servo motor torque generation directions. (Note) Input signals ST2 0 Reverse rotation selection RS2 CN1-3 0 1 1 ST1 0 1 0 1 Torque generation direction Torque is not generated. Forward rotation in driving mode/reverse rotation in regenerative mode Reverse rotation in driving mode/forward rotation in regenerative mode Torque is not generated. DI-1
15 - 15
Symbol SP1
Functions/applications <Speed control mode> Used to select the command speed for operation. When using SP1 to SP3, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. (Note) Input signals SP3 SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Speed command Analog speed command (VC) Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed command 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed command 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed command 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed command 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed command 7 (parameter No.75)
Control mode P S
SP2 SP3
DI-1 DI-1
Note. 0: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN off (open) 1: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN on (short) <Speed control mode> Used to select the command speed for operation. When using SP1 to SP3, make it usable by making the setting of parameter No.43 to 48. (Note) Input signals SP3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Speed limit Analog speed limit (VLA) Internal speed limit 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed limit 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed limit 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed limit 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed limit 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed limit 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed limit 7 (parameter No.75)
Note. 0: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN off (open) 1: SP1/SP2/SP3-VIN on (short) Control change LOP <Position/speed control change mode> Used to select the control mode in the position/speed control change mode. (Note) LOP 0 1 Note. 0: LOP-VIN off (open) 1: LOP-VIN on (short) Servo-on Reset Proportion control Emergency stop Gain changing SON RES PC EMG CDP CN1-8 CN1-4 Same as MR-E- A-QW003. (Refer to section 3.3.2 (1).) DI-1 DI-1 DI-1 DI-1 DI-1 Control mode Position Speed DI-1 Refer to functions/ applications.
15 - 16
Symbol TLA
Functions/applications
I/O division
Control mode P S
Analog To use this signal in the speed control mode, set any of parameters No.43 input to 48 to make TL available. When the analog torque limit (TLA) is valid, torque is limited in the full servo motor output torque range. Apply 0 to 10VDC across TLA-LG. Connect the positive terminal of the power supply to TLA. Maximum torque is generated at 10V. (Refer to section 15.2.5 (1)(a).) Resolution:10bit Used to control torque in the full servo motor output torque range. Apply 0 to 8VDC across TC-LG. Maximum torque is generated at (Refer to section 15.2.5 (2)(a).) The torque at 8V input can be changed using parameter No.26. 8V. Analog input
TC
VC
CN1-26
Apply 0 to 10VDC across VC-LG. Speed set in parameter No.25 is Analog input provided at 10V. (Refer to section 15.2.5 (1)(a).) Resolution:14bit or equivalent Apply 0 to provided at 10VDC across VLA-LG. Speed set in parameter No.25 is Analog 10V. (Refer to section 15.2.5 (2)(c).) input
VLA
15 - 17
Speed reached
SA turns off when servo on (SON) turns off or the servo motor speed has not reached the preset speed with both forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) turned off. SA turns on when the servo motor speed has nearly reached the preset speed. When the preset speed is 30r/min or less, SA always turns on. VLC turns on when speed reaches the value limited using any of the internal speed limits 1 to 7 (parameter No.8 to 10, 72 to 75) or the analog speed limit (VLA) in the torque control mode. VLC turns off when servo on (SON) turns off. TLC turns on when the torque generated reaches the value set to the internal torque limit 1 (parameter No.28) or analog torque limit (TLA). TLC turns off when servo on (SON) turns off. CN1-9 CN1-11 CN1-12 [CN1-12] Same as MR-E- A-QW003. (Refer to section 3.3.2 (2).)
Limiting speed
VLC
DO-1
Limiting torque
TLC
DO-1
Trouble Ready Zero speed Electromagnetic brake interlock Warning Alarm code
Encoder Z-phase pulse (Open collector) Encoder A-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Encoder B-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Encoder Z-phase pulse (Differential line driver) Analog monitor 1 Analog monitor 2
CN1-21
DO-2
LA LAR
CN1-15 CN1-16
LB LBR
CN1-17 CN1-18
LZ LZR
CN1-19 CN1-20
MO1 MO2
CN3-4 CN3-6
15 - 18
Digital I/F power supply input Open collector power input Digital I/F common Control common Shield
15 - 19
15.2.5 Detailed description of the signals (1) Speed control mode (a) Speed setting 1) Speed command and speed The servo motor is run at the speeds set in the parameters or at the speed set in the applied voltage of the analog speed command (VC). A relationship between the analog speed command (VC) applied voltage and the servo motor speed is shown below. In the initial setting, rated speed is 10V. The speed at 10V can be changed using parameter No.25.
Preset rotation speed (Value for parameter No.25) [r/min] Forward rotation (CCW) Speed [r/min] 10 CW direction CCW direction 0 10 VC applied voltage [V] Preset rotation speed (Value for parameter No.25) Reverse rotation (CW)
The following table indicates the rotation direction according to forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) combination.
(Note 1) External input signals ST2 0 0 1 1 ST1 0 1 0 1 Polarity Stop (Servo lock) CCW CW Stop (Servo lock) (Note 2) Rotation direction Analog speed command (VC) 0V Stop (Servo lock) Stop (No servo lock) Stop (Servo lock) Polarity Stop (Servo lock) CW CCW Stop (Servo lock) Internal speed commands Stop (Servo lock) CCW CW Stop (Servo lock)
Note 1. 0: off 1: on 2. Releasing the torque limit during servo lock may cause the servo motor to suddenly rotate according to the position deviation from the instructed position.
The forward rotation start (ST1) and reverse rotation start (ST2) can be assigned to any pins of the connector CN1 using parameters No.43 to 48. Generally, make connection as shown below.
Servo amplifier ST1 ST2 VIN VC LG SD
10 to
10V
15 - 20
2) Speed selection 1 (SP1), speed selection 2 (SP2), speed selection 3 (SP3) and speed command value by making speed selection 1 (SP1), speed selection 2 (SP2) and speed selection 3 (SP3) usable by setting of parameter No.43 to 47, you can choose the speed command values of internal speed commands 1 to 7.
(Note) External input signals SP3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Speed command value Analog speed command (VC) Internal speed command 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed command 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed command 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed command 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed command 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed command 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed command 7 (parameter No.75)
The speed may be changed during rotation. In this case, the values set in parameters No.11 and 12 are used for acceleration/deceleration. When the speed has been specified under any internal speed command, it does not vary due to the ambient temperature. (b) Speed reached (SA) SA-VIN are connected when the servo motor speed nearly reaches the speed set to the internal speed command.
Set speed selection ON OFF
Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 2
ON OFF
15 - 21
CAUTION
Releasing the torque limit during servo lock may cause the servo motor to suddenly rotate according to the position deviation from the instructed position.
1) Torque limit and torque By setting parameter No.28 (internal torque limit 1), torque is always limited to the maximum value during operation. A relationship between the limit value and servo motor torque is shown below.
Max. torque Torque 0 0 100 Torque limit value[ ]
A relationship between the applied voltage of the analog torque limit (TLA) and the torque limit value of the servo motor is shown below. Torque limit values will vary about 5 relative to the voltage depending on products. At the voltage of less than 0.05V, torque may vary as it may not be limited sufficiently. Therefore, use this function at the voltage of 0.05V or more.
Torque limit value[ ] 100 Servo amplifier TL 5 0 to 10V VIN TLA LG 0 0 0.05 10 TLA application voltage [V] TLA application voltage vs. torque limit value SD
2) Torque limit value selection Use parameters No.43 through 48 to enable external torque limit (TL) and internal torque limit (TL1). Torque limit values can be selected as shown in the following table. However, if the parameter No.28 value is less than the limit value selected by TL/TL1, the parameter No.28 value is made valid.
(Note) External input signals TL1 TL 0 0 0 1 1 Note.0: off 1: on 1 0 1 Torque limit value made valid Internal torque limit 1 (parameter No.28) TLA Parameter No.28: Parameter No.28 TLA Parameter No.28: TLA Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.28 Parameter No.76 Parameter No.28: Parameter No.76 TLA Parameter No.76: Parameter No.76 TLA Parameter No.76: TLA
15 - 22
(2) Torque control mode (a) Torque command 1) Torque command and torque A relationship between the applied voltage of the analog torque command (TC) and the torque by the servo motor is shown below. The maximum torque is generated at 8V. Note that the torque at 8V input can be changed with parameter No.26.
CCW direction
0.05 8 TC applied voltage [V] CW direction Max. torque (Note) Reverse rotation (CW)
Generated torque limit values will vary about 5 relative to the voltage depending on products. Also the torque may vary if the voltage is low ( 0.05 to 0.05V) and the actual speed is close to the limit value. In such a case, increase the speed limit value. The following table indicates the torque generation directions determined by the forward rotation selection (RS1) and reverse rotation selection (RS2) when the analog torque command (TC) is used.
(Note) External input signals RS2 0 RS1 0 Polarity Torque is not generated. CCW (reverse rotation in driving mode/forward rotation in regenerative mode) CW (forward rotation in driving mode/reverse rotation in regenerative mode) Torque is not generated. Rotation direction Torque control command (TC) 0V Polarity Torque is not generated. CW (forward rotation in driving mode/reverse rotation in regenerative mode) CCW (reverse rotation in driving mode/forward rotation in regenerative mode) Torque is not generated.
1 Note. 0: off 1: on
8 to 8V
15 - 23
2) Analog torque command offset Using parameter No.30, the offset voltage of voltage as shown below.
Max. torque Generated torque
999 to
(b) Torque limit By setting parameter No.28 (internal torque limit 1), torque is always limited to the maximum value during operation. A relationship between limit value and servo motor torque is as in (1)(c) of this section. Note that the analog torque limit (TLA) is unavailable. (c) Speed limit 1) Speed limit value and speed The speed is limited to the values set in parameters No.8 to 10, 72 to 75 (internal speed limits 1 to 7) or the value set in the applied voltage of the analog speed limit (VLA). A relationship between the analog speed limit (VLA) applied voltage and the servo motor speed is shown below. When the servo motor speed reaches the speed limit value, torque control may become unstable. Make the set value more than 100r/min greater than the desired speed limit value.
CCW direction 0 10 VLA applied voltage [V] Rated speed Reverse rotation (CW)
The following table indicates the limit direction according to forward rotation selection (RS1) and reverse rotation selection (RS2) combination.
(Note) External input signals RS1 1 0 Note.0: off 1: on RS2 0 1 Speed limit direction Analog speed limit (VLA) Polarity Polarity CCW CW CW CCW Internal speed commands CCW CW
15 - 24
10 to
10V
2) Speed selection 1(SP1)/speed selection 2(SP2)/speed selection 3(SP3) and speed limit values Choose any of the speed settings made by the internal speed limits 1 to 7 using speed selection 1(SP1), speed selection 2(SP2) and speed selection 3(SP3) or the speed setting made by the analog speed limit (VLA), as indicated below.
(Note) External input signals SP3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 Note.0: off 1: on SP2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 SP1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Speed limit value Analog speed limit (VLA) Internal speed limit 1 (parameter No.8) Internal speed limit 2 (parameter No.9) Internal speed limit 3 (parameter No.10) Internal speed limit 4 (parameter No.72) Internal speed limit 5 (parameter No.73) Internal speed limit 6 (parameter No.74) Internal speed limit 7 (parameter No.75)
When the internal speed limits 1 to 7 are used to command the speed, the speed does not vary with the ambient temperature. 3) Limiting speed (VLC) VLC turns on when the servo motor speed reaches the speed limited using any of the internal speed limits 1 to 7 or the analog speed limit (VLA).
15 - 25
(3) Speed/torque control change mode Set "0003" in parameter No.0 to switch to the speed/torque control change mode. (a) Control change (LOP) Use control change (LOP) to switch between the speed control mode and the torque control mode from an external contact. Relationships between LOP and control modes are indicated below.
(Note) LOP 0 1 Note.0: off 1: on Servo control mode Speed control mode Torque control mode
The control mode may be changed at any time. A change timing chart is shown below.
Torque Speed Speed control mode control mode control mode Control change (LOP) ON OFF
Note. When the start (ST1 ST2) is switched off as soon as the mode is changed to speed control, the servo motor comes to a stop according to the deceleration time constant.
(b) Speed setting in speed control mode Same as (1)(a). (c) Torque limit in speed control mode Same as (1)(c). (d) Speed limit in torque control mode Same as (2)(c). (e) Torque control in torque control mode Same as (2)(a). (f) Torque limit in torque control mode Same as (2)(b).
15 - 26
15.3 Startup
WARNING
Do not operate the switches with wet hands. You may get an electric shock. Before starting operation, check the parameters. Some machines may perform unexpected operation. Take safety measures, e.g. provide covers, to prevent accidental contact of hands and parts (cables, etc.) with the servo amplifier heat sink, regenerative resistor, servo motor, etc. since they may be hot while power is on or for some time after power-off. Their temperatures may be high and you may get burnt or a parts may damaged. During operation, never touch the rotating parts of the servo motor. Doing so can cause injury.
CAUTION
Perform pre-operation checks while referring to section 4.1. Connect the servo motor with a machine after confirming that the servo motor operates properly alone. Use parameter No.0 to choose the control mode used. After setting, this parameter is made valid by switching power off, then on. 15.3.1 Speed control mode (1) Power on 1) Switch off the servo-on (SON). 2) When power is switched on, the display shows "r (servo motor speed)", and in two second later, shows data. (2) Test operation Confirm servo motor operation by operating JOG of test operation mode at lowest speed possible. (Refer to section 6.8.2.)
15 - 27
(3) Parameter setting Set the parameters according to the structure and specifications of the machine. Refer to chapter 5 for the parameter definitions and to section 6.5 for the setting method.
Parameter No. 0 Name Control mode, regenerative option selection Setting 0 2 Speed control mode Regenerative option is not used. 12 1 Function selection 1 1 2 8 9 10 11 12 13 Auto tuning Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Acceleration time constant Deceleration time constant S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant 1000 1500 2000 1000 500 0 5 Middle response (initial value) is selected. Auto tuning mode 1 is selected. Set 1000r/min. Set 1500r/min. Set 2000r/min. Set 1000ms. Set 500ms. Not used Input filter 3.555ms (initial value) Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) is used. Description
Turn the power off to validate changes in parameters No.0 and 1. Then switch power on again to make the set parameter values valid. (4) Servo-on Switch the servo-on in the following procedure. 1) Switch on power supply. 2) Switch on the servo-on (SON). When placed in the servo-on status, the servo amplifier is ready to operate and the servo motor is locked. (5) Start Using speed selection 1 (SP1) and speed selection 2 (SP2), choose the servo motor speed. Turn on forward rotation start (ST1) to run the motor in the forward rotation (CCW) direction or reverse rotation start (ST2) to run it in the reverse rotation (CW) direction. At first, set a speed as low as possible and check the rotation direction, etc. If it does not run in the intended direction, check the input signal. On the status display, check the speed, load factor, etc. of the servo motor. When machine operation check is over, check automatic operation with the host controller or the like. This servo amplifier has a real-time auto tuning function under model adaptive control. Performing operation automatically adjusts gains. The optimum tuning results are provided by setting the response level appropriate for the machine in parameter No.2. (Refer to chapter 7.) (6) Stop In any of the following statuses, the servo amplifier interrupts and stops the operation of the servo motor. Refer to section 3.9 for the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake. Note that simultaneous ON or simultaneous OFF of forward rotation stroke end (LSP), reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) OFF and forward rotation start (ST1) or reverse rotation start (ST2) has the same stop pattern as described below. (a) Servo-on (SON) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the servo motor coasts. (b) Alarm occurrence When an alarm occurs, the base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. 15 - 28
15 - 29
15.3.2 Torque control mode (1) Power on 1) Switch off the servo-on (SON). 2) When power is switched on, the display shows "U (torque command voltage)", and in two second later, shows data. (2) Test operation Using jog operation in the test operation mode, make sure that the servo motor operates. (Refer to section 6.8.2.) (3) Parameter setting Set the parameters according to the structure and specifications of the machine. Refer to chapter 5 for the parameter definitions and to section 6.5 for the setting method.
Parameter No. 0 Name Control mode, regenerative option selection Setting 0 4 Torque control mode Regenerative option is not used. 02 1 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 28 Function selection 1 Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Internal speed command 1 Acceleration time constant Deceleration time constant S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant Torque command time constant Internal torque limit 1 1000 1500 2000 1000 500 0 2000 50 Input filter 3.555ms (initial value) Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR) is used. Set 1000r/min. Set 1500r/min. Set 2000r/min. Set 1000ms. Set 500ms. Not used Set 2000r/min. Controlled to 50 output Description
Turn the power off after setting parameters No.0 and 1. Then switch power on again to make the set parameter values valid. (4) Servo-on Switch the servo-on in the following procedure. 1) Switch on power supply. 2) Switch on the servo-on (SON). When placed in the servo-on status, the servo amplifier is ready to operate and the servo motor is locked. (5) Start Using speed selection 1 (SP1) and speed selection 2 (SP2), choose the servo motor speed. Turn on forward rotation select (DI4) to run the motor in the forward rotation (CCW) direction or reverse rotation select (DI3) to run it in the reverse rotation (CW) direction, generating torque. At first, set a low speed and check the rotation direction, etc. If it does not run in the intended direction, check the input signal. On the status display, check the speed, load factor, etc. of the servo motor. When machine operation check is over, check automatic operation with the host controller or the like.
15 - 30
(6) Stop In any of the following statuses, the servo amplifier interrupts and stops the operation of the servo motor. Refer to section 3.9 for the servo motor equipped with electromagnetic brake. (a) Servo-on (SON) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the servo motor coasts. (b) Alarm occurrence When an alarm occurs, the base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. (c) Emergency stop (EMG) OFF The base circuit is shut off and the dynamic brake is operated to bring the servo motor to a sudden stop. Alarm AL.E6 (servo emergency stop warning) occurs. (d) Simultaneous ON or simultaneous OFF of forward rotation selection (RS1) and reverse rotation selection (RS2) The servo motor coasts. POINT A sudden stop indicates deceleration to a stop at the deceleration time constant of zero.
15 - 31
15.4 Parameters POINT Before changing the settings of parameters No.20 through 84, cancel write protection while referring to section 5.1.1. For any parameter whose symbol is preceded by *, set the parameter value and switch power off once, then switch it on again to make that parameter setting valid. The symbols in the control mode column of the table indicate the following modes: S: Speed control mode T: Torque control mode 15.4.1 Item list
Class No. 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Basic parameters 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 SC1 SC2 SC3 STA STB STC TQC *SNO *BPS MOD *DMD *BLK PG1 Position loop gain 1 For manufacture setting Internal speed command 1 Internal speed limit 1 Internal speed command 2 Internal speed limit 2 Internal speed command 3 Internal speed limit 3 Acceleration time constant Deceleration time constant S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant Torque command time constant Station number setting Serial communication function selection, alarm history clear Analog monitor output Status display selection Parameter block S T S T S T S T S T S T T S T S T S T S T S T S Symbol *STY *OP1 ATU Name Control mode, regenerative option selection Function selection 1 Auto tuning For manufacturer setting Control mode S T S T S Initial value (Note 1) 0002 0105 1 1 100 35 3 100 100 500 500 1000 1000 0 0 0 0 0 0000 0100 0000 0000 r/min r/min r/min r/min r/min r/min ms ms ms ms station rad/s Unit Customer setting
15 - 32
Symbol *OP2 *OP4 ZSP VCM TLC *ENR TL1 VCO TLO MO1 MO2 MBR GD2 PG2 VG1 VG2 VIC VDC *DIA *DI1 *DI2 *DI3 *DI4 *DI5 *DI6 *LSPN *DO1 *OP6 *OP8 *OP9 SIC NH1 NH2 LPF GD2B Function selection 2 For manufacturer setting Function selection 4 For manufacturer setting Zero speed
Name
Unit
Customer setting
r/min
Analog speed command maximum speed Analog speed limit maximum speed Analog torque command maximum output Encoder output pulses Internal torque limit 1 Analog speed command offset Analog speed limit offset Analog torque command offset Analog torque limit offset Analog monitor 1 offset Analog monitor 2 offset Electromagnetic brake sequence output Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Position loop gain 2 Speed loop gain 1 Speed loop gain 2 Speed integral compensation Speed differential compensation For manufacturer setting Input signal automatic ON selection Input signal selection 1 Input signal selection 2 (CN1-4) Input signal selection 3 (CN1-3) Input signal selection 4 (CN1-5) Input signal selection 5 (CN1-6) Input signal selection 6 (CN1-7) LSP/LSN input terminals selection Output signal selection 1 For manufacturer setting Function selection 6 For manufacturer setting Function selection 8 Function selection 9 For manufacturer setting Serial communication time-out selection For manufacturer setting Machine resonance suppression filter 1 Machine resonance suppression filter 2 Low-pass filter/adaptive vibration suppression control Ratio of load inertia moment to Servo motor inertia moment 2 For manufacturer setting
(Note 3)0 (r/min) (Note 3)0 (r/min) 100 4000 100 (Note 2) (Note 2) 0 0 0 0 100 70 35 177 817 48 980 0 0000 0002 0111 0882 0995 0000 0000 0403 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0 10 0000 0000 0000 70 100 Multiplier ( 10 1) s mV mV mV mV mV mV ms Multiplier ( 10 1) rad/s rad/s rad/s ms pulse /rev
Expansion parameters 1
VG2B VICB
Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Speed integral compensation changing ratio
S S
100 100
15 - 33
Symbol *CDP CDS CDT Gain changing selection Gain changing condition Gain changing time constant For manufacturer setting
Name
Control mode S S S
Unit
Customer setting
(Note 2) ms
Internal speed command 4 Internal speed limit 4 Internal speed command 5 Internal speed limit 5 Internal speed command 6 Internal speed limit 6 Internal speed command 7 Internal speed limit 7 Internal torque limit 2 For manufacturer setting
S T S T S T S T S T
200 300 500 800 100 100 10000 10 10 100 100 100 0000
Note 1. Depends on the capacity of the servo amplifier. 2. Depends on the parameter No.65 setting. 3. The setting of "0" provides the rated servo motor speed.
15 - 34
Select the control mode. 0: Speed 1: Speed and torque 2: Torque Motor series selection 0: HF-KE W1-S100 1: HF-SE JW1-S100 Selection of regenerative option 0: Regenerative option is not used For the servo amplifier of 200W or lower, regenerative resistor is not used. For the servo amplifier of 400W or higher, built-in regenerative resistor is used. 2: MR-RB032 3: MR-RB12 4: MR-RB32 5: MR-RB30 6: MR-RB50 (Cooling fan is required) Motor capacity selection 0: 100W 1: 200W 2: 400W 3: 500W 4: 750W 5: 1kW 6: 1.5kW 7: 2kW
Basic parameters
POINT Wrong setting may cause the regenerative option to burn. If the regenerative option selected is not for use with the servo amplifier, parameter error (AL.37) occurs. 1 *OP1 Function selection 1 Used to select the input signal filter, the function of pin CN1-12. 0002 Refer to name and function column. S T
0 0
Input signal filter If external input signal causes chattering due to noise, etc., input filter is used to suppress it. 0: None 1: 1.777[ms] 2: 3.555[ms] 3: 5.333[ms] CN1-12 function selection 0: Zero Speed detection signal 1: Electromagnetic brake interlock (MBR)
15 - 35
Class
No. 2
Symbol ATU
Name and function Auto tuning Used to selection the response level, etc. for execution of auto tuning. Refer to chapter 7.
Unit
Control mode S
0
Auto tuning response level setting Set value Response level Low response Machine resonance frequency guideline
Basic parameters
1 15Hz 20Hz 2 25Hz 3 30Hz 4 35Hz 5 45Hz 6 55Hz 7 Middle 70Hz 8 response 85Hz 9 A 105Hz 130Hz B 160Hz C 200Hz D High 240Hz E response F 300Hz If the machine hunts or generates large gear sound, decrease the set value. To improve performance, e.g. shorten the settling time, increase the set value. Gain adjustment mode selection (For more information, refer to section 7.1.1.) Set Gain adjustment mode Description value Interpolation mode Fixes position control gain 1 0 (parameter No.6). 1 2 Auto tuning mode 1 Auto tuning mode 2 Ordinary auto tuning. Fixes the load inertia moment ratio set in parameter No.34. Response level setting can be changed. Simple manual adjustment. Manual adjustment of all gains.
3 4
3 4 5 6 PG1
For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means. Position loop gain 1 Used to set the gain of position loop. Increase the gain to improve track ability in response to the position command. When auto turning mode 1,2 is selected, the result of auto turning is automatically used. To use this parameter, set " 1 " to parameter No.20 to validate servo lock at stop. For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
1 1 100 35 S
15 - 36
Class
No. 8
Symbol SC1
Name and function Internal speed command 1 Used to set speed 1 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 1 Used to set speed 1 of internal speed limits.
SC2
Internal speed command 2 Used to set speed 2 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 2 Used to set speed 2 of internal speed limits.
500
10
SC3
Internal speed command 3 Used to set speed 3 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 3 Used to set speed 3 of internal speed limits.
1000
11
STA
Acceleration time constant Used to set the acceleration time required to reach the rated speed from 0r/min in response to the analog speed command and internal speed commands 1 to 7. If the preset speed command is lower than the rated speed, Speed acceleration/deceleration time Rated will be shorter. speed
Setting Control range mode 0 to r/min S instantaneous permiT ssible speed r/min 0 to S instantaneous permiT ssible speed r/min 0 to S instantaneous permiT ssible speed S T ms 0 to 20000 Unit
12
STB
13
STC
Time Parameter Parameter No.11 setting No.12 setting For example for the servo motor of 3000r/min rated speed, set 3000 (3s) to increase speed from 0r/min to 1000r/min in 1 second. Deceleration time constant Used to set the deceleration time required to reach 0r/min from the rated speed in response to the analog speed command and internal speed commands 1 to 7. S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant Used to smooth start/stop of the servo motor. Set the time of the arc part for S-pattern acceleration/deceleration.
Speed command Speed Servo motor
Zero speed
Basic parameters
ms
0 to 1000
S T
Time
STA: Acceleration time constant (parameter No.11) STB: Deceleration time constant (parameter No.12) STC: S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant (parameter No.13)
Long setting of STA (acceleration time constant) or STB (deceleration time constant) may produce an error in the time of the arc part for the setting of the S-pattern acceleration/deceleration time constant.
The upper limit value of the actual arc part time is limited by 2000000 2000000 for acceleration or by for deceleration. STA STB (Example) At the setting of STA 20000, STB 5000 and STC 200, the actual arc part times are as follows. During acceleration: 100[ms] Limited to 100[ms] since 2000000 100[ms] 200[ms]. 20000 200[ms] as set since During deceleration: 200[ms] 2000000 5000 400[ms] 200[ms].
15 - 37
Class
No. 14
Symbol TQC
Name and function Torque command time constant Used to set the constant of a low-pass filter in response to the torque command. Torque command Torque
After filtered
Initial value 0
Unit ms
Control mode T
TQC
Time
15 Basic parameters
*SNO
Station number setting Used to specify the station number for serial communication. Always set one station to one axis of servo amplifier. If one station number is set to two or more stations, normal communication cannot be made. Serial communication function selection, alarm history clear Used to select the serial communication baud rate, select various communication conditions, and clear the alarm history.
station
S T
16
*BPS
0000
S T
0
Serial baud rate selection 0: 9600 [bps] 1: 19200[bps] 2: 38400[bps] 3: 57600[bps] Alarm history clear 0: Invalid (not cleared) 1: Valid (cleared) When alarm history clear is made valid, the alarm history is cleared at next power-on. After the alarm history is cleared, the setting is automatically made invalid (reset to 0). Serial communication response delay time 0: Invalid 1: Valid, reply sent after delay time of 800 s or more
15 - 38
Class
No. 17
Symbol MOD
Name and function Analog monitor output Used to selection the signal provided to the analog monitor (MO1) analog monitor (MO2) output. (Refer to section 5.2.2)
Unit
Control mode S T
Setting Analog monitor 2 (MO2) Analog monitor 1 (MO1) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B Bus voltage ( 8V/400V) Servo motor speed ( Torque ( Torque ( Servo motor speed ( Current command ( Cannot be used. 8V/max. speed) 8V/max. speed) 8 V/max. current command) 8V/max. torque) 8V/max. torque)
Basic parameters
18
*DMD
Status display selection Used to select the status display shown at power-on.
0000
0 0
Selection of status display at power-on 0: Cumulative feedback pulses 1: Servo motor speed 2: Cannot be used 3: Cannot be used 4: Cannot be used 7: Regenerative load ratio 8: Effective load ratio 9: Peak load ratio A: Instantaneous torque B: Within one-revolution position low C: Within one-revolution position high D: Load inertia moment ratio E: Bus voltage Status display at power-on in corresponding control mode 0: Depends on the control mode. Control Mode Speed Speed/torque Torque Status display at power-on Servo motor speed Servo motor speed/ analog torque command voltage Analog torque command voltage
S T
15 - 39
Class
No. 19
Symbol *BLK
Name and function Parameter block Used to select the reference and write ranges of the parameters. Operation can be performed for the parameters marked . Set value 0000 (Initial value) Basic parameters No.0 to No.19 Expansion parameters 1 No.20 to No.49 Expansion parameters 2 No.50 to No.84
Unit
Control mode S T
Operation Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write Reference Write
Basic parameters
15 - 40
Class
No. 20
Symbol *OP2
Name and function Function selection 2 Used to select restart after instantaneous power failure, servo lock at a stop in speed control mode, and slight vibration suppression control.
Unit
Control mode
Restart after instantaneous power failure If the power supply voltage has returned to normal after an undervoltage status caused by the reduction of the input power supply voltage in the speed control mode, the servo motor can be restarted by merely turning on the start signal without resetting the alarm.
Expansion parameters 1
0: Invalid (Undervoltage alarm (AL.10) occurs.) 1: Valid Stop-time servo lock selection The shaft can be servo-locked to remain still at a stop in the internal speed control mode. 0: Valid 1: Invalid Slight vibration suppression control Made valid when auto tuning selection is set to "0400" in parameter No.2. Used to suppress vibration at a stop. 0: Invalid 1: Valid Encoder cable communication system selection 0: Two-wire type 1: Four-wire type Incorrect setting will result in an encoder alarm 1 (AL.16) or encoder alarm 2 (AL.20).
S T
21
0000
15 - 41
Class
No. 22
Symbol *OP4
Name and function Function selection 4 Used to select stop processing at forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) off, choose TLC/VLC output and choose VC/VLA voltage averaging.
Unit
Control mode
0
How to make a stop when forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is valid. (Refer to section 5.2.3.) 0: Sudden stop 1: Slow stop TLC/VLC output selection Select the connector pin at which Torque Limit (TLC) or Speed Limit (VLC) is output. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 Connector pin No. Not output CN1-11 CN1-9 CN1-10 CN1-12
S T
Expansion parameters 1
VC/VLA voltage averaging Used to set the filtering time when the analog speed command (VC) voltage or analog speed limit (VLA) is imported. Set 0 to vary the speed to voltage fluctuation in real time. Increase the set value to vary the speed slower to voltage fluctuation. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 Filtering time [ms] 0 0.444 0.888 1.777 3.555
23 24 ZSP
For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means. Zero speed Used to set the output range of the zero speed (ZSP). Analog speed command maximum speed Used to set the speed at the maximum input voltage (10V) of the analog speed command (VC). Set "0" to select the rated speed of the servo motor connected. Analog speed limit maximum speed Used to set the speed at the maximum input voltage (10V) of the analog speed limit (VLA). Set "0" to select the rated speed of the servo motor connected.
25
VCM
0 r/min
0 r/min
26
TLC
Analog torque command maximum output Used to set the output torque at the analog torque command voltage (TC 8V) of 8V on the assumption that the maximum torque is 100[ ]. For example, set 50 to output (maximum torque 50/100) at the TC of 8V.
100
15 - 42
Class
No. 27
Symbol *ENR
Name and function Encoder output pulses Used to set the encoder pulses (A-phase or B-phase) output by the servo amplifier. Set the value 4 times greater than the A-phase or B-phase pulses. You can use parameter No.54 to choose the output pulse designation or output division ratio setting. The number of A B-phase pulses actually output is 1/4 times greater than the preset number of pulses. The maximum output frequency is 1.3Mpps (after multiplication by 4). Use this parameter within this range. For output pulse designation Set "0 " (initial value) in parameter No.54. Set the number of pulses per servo motor revolution. Output pulse set value [pulses/rev] At the setting of 5600, for example, the actually A B-phase pulses output are as indicated below. 5600 A B-phase output pulses 1400[pulse] 4 For output division ratio setting Set "1 " in parameter No.54. The number of pulses per servo motor revolution is divided by the set value. Resolution per servo motor revolution Output pulse [pulses/rev] Set value At the setting of 8, for example, the actually A B-phase pulses output are as indicated below.
A B-phase output pulses 10000 8 1 4 313[pulse]
Expansion parameters 1
28
TL1
Internal torque limit 1 Set this parameter to limit servo motor torque on the assumption that the maximum torque is 100[ ]. When 0 is set, torque is not produced. (Note) TL 0 1 Torque limit Internal torque limit 1 (Parameter No.28) Analog torque limit internal torque limit 1 : Analog torque limit Analog torque limit internal torque limit 1 : Internal torque limit 1
100
0 to 100
S T
Note. 0 :off 1 :on When torque is output in analog monitor output, this set value is the maximum output voltage ( 8V). (Refer to section 15.2.5 (1)(c).) Analog speed command offset Depends Used to set the offset voltage of the analog speed command (VC). on servo For example, if CCW rotation is provided by switching on forward rotation amplifier start (ST1) with 0V applied to VC, set a negative value. When automatic VC offset is used, the automatically offset value is set to this parameter. (Refer to section 15.5.3.) The initial value is the value provided by the automatic VC offset function before shipment at the VC-LG voltage of 0V. Analog speed limit offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog speed limit (VLA). For example, if CCW rotation is provided by switching on forward rotation selection (RS1) with 0V applied to VLA, set a negative value. When automatic VC offset is used, the automatically offset value is set to this parameter. (Refer to section 15.5.3.) The initial value is the value provided by the automatic VC offset function before shipment at the VLA-LG voltage of 0V.
29
VCO
mV
999 to 999
15 - 43
Class
No. 30
Symbol TLO
Name and function Analog torque command offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog torque command (TC). Analog torque limit offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog torque limit (TLA). Analog monitor 1 offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog monitor 1 (MO1). Analog monitor 2 offset Used to set the offset voltage of the analog monitor 2 (MO2). Electromagnetic brake sequence output Used to set the delay time (Tb) between electronic brake interlock (MBR) and the base drive circuit is shut-off. Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment Used to set the ratio of the load inertia moment to the servo motor shaft inertia moment. When auto tuning mode 1 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. (Refer to section 7.1.1.) In this case, it varies between 0 and 1000. Position loop gain 2 Used to set the gain of the position loop. Set this parameter to increase the position response to level load disturbance. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1,2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. To use this parameter, set " 1 " to parameter No.20 to validate servo lock at stop. Speed loop gain 1 Normally this parameter setting need not be changed. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2, manual mode and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed loop gain 2 Set this parameter when vibration occurs on machines of low rigidity or large backlash. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed integral compensation Used to set the integral time constant of the speed loop. Higher setting increases the response level but is liable to generate vibration and/or noise. When auto tuning mode 1 2 and interpolation mode is selected, the result of auto tuning is automatically used. Speed differential compensation Used to set the differential compensation. Made valid when the proportion control (PC) is switched on. For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Initial value 0
Unit mV
Setting range 999 to 999 999 to 999 999 to 999 0 to 1000 0 to 3000
Control mode T S S T S T S T
31 32 33
0 0 100
mV mV ms
34
GD2
70
Multiplier ( 10 1)
S T
35
PG2
35
rad/s
1 to 1000
Expansion parameters 1
36
VG1
177
rad/s
20 to 8000
37
VG2
817
rad/s
20 to 20000
38
VIC
48
ms
1 to 1000
39
VDC
980
0 to 1000
40
15 - 44
Class
No. 41
Symbol *DIA
Name and function Input signal automatic ON selection Used to set automatic servo-on (SON) forward rotation stroke end (LSP) reverse rotation stroke end (LSN).
Unit
Control mode S T
0
Servo-on (SON) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring) Forward rotation stroke end (LSP) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring) Reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) input selection 0: Switched on/off by external input. 1: Switched on automatically in servo amplifier. (No need of external wiring)
Expansion parameters 1
42
*DI1
Input signal selection 1 Used to assign the control mode changing signal input pins and to set the clear (CR).
0002
0 0 0
Control change (LOP) input pin assignment Used to set the control mode change signal input connector pins. Note that this parameter is made valid when parameter No.0 is set to select internal speed/torque change mode. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 Connector pin No. CN1-4 CN1-3 CN1-5 CN1-6 CN1-7
S/T
If forward rotation stroke end (LSP) or reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to any pin with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used.
15 - 45
Class
No. 43
Symbol *DI2
Name and function Input signal selection 2 (CN1-4) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 4. Note that the setting digit and assigned signal differ according to the control mode.
Unit
Control mode S T
1
Speed control mode Torque control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 4 selected.
Signals that may be assigned in each control mode are indicated below by their symbols. Setting of any other signal will be invalid.
Set value 0 1 SON RES PC TL CR SP1 SP2 ST1 ST2 SP3 SON RES PC TL CR SP1 SP2 RS2 RS1 SP3 (Note) Control mode S T
Expansion parameters 1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
TL1 CDP
TL1 CDP
Note: P: Position control mode S: Internal speed control mode This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 4. If rotation stroke end (LSP) or reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to pin 4 of CN1 with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used.
15 - 46
Class
No. 44
Symbol *DI3
Name and function Input signal selection 3 (CN1-3) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 3. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
Unit
Control mode S T
2
Speed control mode Torque control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 3 selected.
45
*DI4
Expansion parameters 1
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 3. If forward rotation stroke end (LSP) or reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to pin 3 of CN1 with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used. Input signal selection 4 (CN1-5) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 5. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
0995
5
Speed control mode Torque control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 5 selected.
S T
46
*DI5
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 5. If forward stroke end (LSP) or reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to pin 5 of CN1 with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used. Input signal selection 5 (CN1-6) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 6. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
0000
0
Speed control mode Torque control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 6 selected.
S T
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change (LOP) to CN1-pin 6. If reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to pin 6 of CN1 with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used.
15 - 47
Class
No. 47
Symbol *DI6
Name and function Input signal selection 6 (CN1-7) Allows any input signal to be assigned to CN1-pin 7. The assignable signals and setting method are the same as in input signal selection 2 (parameter No.43).
Unit
Control mode S T
0
Speed control mode Torque control mode Input signals of CN1-pin 7 selected.
48 Expansion parameters 1
This parameter is unavailable when parameter No.42 is set to assign the control change signal (LOP) to CN1-pin 7. If forward rotation stroke end (LSP) is assigned to pin 7 of CN1 with parameter No.48, this parameter cannot be used. *LSPN LSP/LSN input terminal selection Select the pins where the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) and reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) will be assigned. If the signals have already been assigned using parameter No.42 to 47, this parameter setting has preference. However, if forward rotation stroke end (LSP) is assigned to pin 6 of CN1 (default setting), the setting of parameter No.46 takes priority. Similarly, if reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) is assigned to pin 7 of CN1 (default setting), the setting of parameter No .47 takes priority.
0403
0
Select the pin where the forward rotation stroke end (LSP) will be assigned. Set value 0 1 2 3 4 5 Connector pin No. CN1-5 CN1-4 CN1-6 CN1-7 CN1-3
Select the pin where the reverse rotation stroke end (LSN) will be assigned. The settings are the same as those of the first digit.
15 - 48
Class
No. 49
Symbol *DO1
Name and function Output signal selection 1 Used to select the connector pins to output the alarm code and warning (WNG).
Unit
Control mode S T
0 0
Setting of alarm code output
Set value 0 1
Connector pins
CN1-10 SA CN1-11 RD CN1-12 ZP
(Note) Alarm code Alarm CN1 CN1 CN1 display pin 10 pin 11 pin 12 88888 AL.12 AL.13 AL.15 0 0 0 AL.17 AL.19 AL.37 AL.8A AL.8E 0 1 1 0 0 0 AL.30 AL.33 AL.10 AL.45 1 1 0 AL.46 AL.50 AL.51 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 1 AL.24 AL.32 AL.31 AL.16 AL.1A AL.20 Watchdog
Name
Memory error 1 Clock error Memory error 2 Board error 2 Memory error 3 Parameter error
Serial communication time-out error
Expansion parameters 1
Serial communication error Regenerative error Overvoltage Undervoltage Main circuit device overheat Servo motor overheat Overload 1 Overload 2 Main circuit Overcurrent Overspeed Encoder error 1 Motor combination error Encoder error 2
Note. 0: Pin-VIN off (open) 1: Pin-VIN on (short) Setting of warning (WNG) output Select the connector pin to output warning. The old signal before selection will be unavailable. Set value Connector pin No. 0 Not output. 1 CN1-11 2 CN1-9 3 CN1-10 4 CN1-12
15 - 49
Class
No. 50 51
Symbol
Name and function For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Unit
Setting range
Control mode
*OP6
Function selection 6 Used to select the operation to be performed when the reset (RES) switches on.
0 0
Operation to be performed when the reset (RES) switches on 0: Base circuit not switched off 1: Base circuit switched off
S T
52 53 *OP8
For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means. Function selection 8 Used to select the protocol of serial communication.
0
Protocol checksum selection 0: Yes (checksum added) 1: No (checksum not added) Protocol checksum selection 0: With station numbers 1: No station numbers
Expansion parameters 2
54
*OP9
Function selection 9 Use to select the command pulse rotation direction, encoder output pulse direction and encoder pulse output setting.
0000
0 0
Encoder pulse output phase changing Changes the phases of A B-phase encoder pulses output . Set value 0
A-phase B-phase A-phase B-phase Servo motor rotation direction
S T
CCW
A-phase B-phase A-phase B-phase
CW
Encoder output pulse setting selection (refer to parameter No.27) 0: Output pulse designation 1: Division ratio setting
55 56 SIC
For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means. Serial communication time-out selection Used to set the communication protocol time-out period in [s]. When you set "0", time-out check is not made. For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
0000 0 s 10 0 1 to 60 S T
57
15 - 50
Class
No. 58
Symbol NH1
Name and function Machine resonance suppression filter 1 Used to selection the machine resonance suppression filter. (Refer to section 8.2.)
Unit
Setting range
Refer to name and function column.
Control mode S T
0
Notch frequency selection Set "00" when you have set adaptive vibration suppression control to be "valid" or "held" (parameter No.60: 1 or 2 ).
Setting Setting Setting Setting Frequency Frequency Frequency Frequency value value value value
00 01 02 03
08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F
Expansion parameters 2
04 05 06 07
59
NH2
Machine resonance suppression filter 2 Used to set the machine resonance suppression filter.
0000
0
Notch frequency Same setting as in parameter No.58 However, you need not set "00" if you have set adaptive vibration suppression control to be "valid" or "held". Notch depth Same setting as in parameter No.58
S T
15 - 51
Class
No. 60
Symbol LPF
Name and function Low-pass filter/adaptive vibration suppression control Used to selection the low-pass filter and adaptive vibration suppression control. (Refer to chapter 8.)
Unit
Setting range
Refer to name and function column.
Control mode S T
0
Low-pass filter selection 0: Valid (Automatic adjustment) 1: Invalid VG2 setting 10 When you choose "valid", 2 (1 GD2 setting 0.1) [Hz] bandwidth filter is set automatically. Adaptive vibration suppression control selection Choosing "valid" or "held" in adaptive vibration suppression control selection makes the machine resonance suppression filter 1 (parameter No.58) invalid. 0: Invalid 1: Valid Machine resonance frequency is always detected and the filter is generated in response to resonance to suppress machine vibration. 2: Held The characteristics of the filter generated so far are held, and detection of machine resonance is stopped. Adaptive vibration suppression control sensitivity selection Used to set the sensitivity of machine resonance detection. 0: Normal 1: Large sensitivity
Expansion parameters 2
61
GD2B
Ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment 2 Used to set the ratio of load inertia moment to servo motor inertia moment when gain changing is valid. For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
70
Multiplier ( 10 1)
0 to 3000
62 63 VG2B
Speed control gain 2 changing ratio Used to set the ratio of changing the speed control gain 2 when gain changing is valid. Made valid when auto tuning is invalid. Speed integral compensation changing ratio Used to set the ratio of changing the speed integral compensation when gain changing is valid. Made valid when auto tuning is invalid.
64
VICB
100
15 - 52
Class
No. 65
Symbol *CDP
Name and function Gain changing selection Used to select the gain changing condition. (Refer to section 8.5.)
Unit
Control mode S
0 0 0
Gain changing selection Gains are changed in accordance with the settings of parameters No.61 to 64 under any of the following conditions: 0: Invalid 1: Gain changing (CDP) is ON 2: For manufacturer setting 3: For manufacturer setting 4: Servo motor speed is equal to higher than parameter No.66 setting
66
CDS
Gain changing condition Used to set the value of gain changing condition (command frequency, droop pulses, servo motor speed) selected in parameter No.65. The set value unit changes with the changing condition item. (Refer to section 8.5.) Gain changing time constant Used to set the time constant at which the gains will change in response to the conditions set in parameters No.65 and 66. (Refer to section 8.5.) For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
10
10 to 9999 0 to 100
67 Expansion parameters 2
CDT
68 69 70 71 72 SC4
0 1 1 1
Internal speed command 4 Used to set speed 4 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 4 Used to set speed 4 of internal speed limits.
200
r/min
0 to instantaneous permissible speed 0 to instantaneous permissible speed 0 to instantaneous permissible speed 0 to instantaneous permissible speed
73
SC5
Internal speed command 5 Used to set speed 5 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 5 Used to set speed 5 of internal speed limits.
300
r/min
74
SC6
Internal speed command 6 Used to set speed 6 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 6 Used to set speed 6 of internal speed limits.
500
r/min
75
SC7
Internal speed command 7 Used to set speed 7 of internal speed commands. Internal speed limit 7 Used to set speed 7 of internal speed limits.
800
r/min
15 - 53
Class
No. 76
Symbol TL2
Name and function Internal torque limit 2 Set this parameter to limit servo motor torque on the assumption that the maximum torque is 100[ ]. When 0 is set, torque is not produced. When torque is output in analog monitor output, this set value is the maximum output voltage ( 8V). For manufacturer setting Do not change this value by any means.
Unit
Control mode S T
Expansion parameters 2
77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84
15 - 54
15.5 Display and operation POINT For the alarm mode, parameter mode output signal (DO) forcible output and test operation mode, refer to chapter 6. 15.5.1 Display flowchart Use the display (5-digit, 7-segment LED) on the front panel of the servo amplifier for status display, parameter setting, etc. Set the parameters before operation, diagnose an alarm, confirm external sequences, and/or confirm the operation status. Press the "MODE" "UP" or "DOWN" button once to move to the next screen. To refer to or set the expansion parameters, make them valid with parameter No.19 (parameter write disable).
button MODE
Status display Diagnosis Alarm
Basic parameters Expansion parameters 1 Expansion parameters 2
Sequence
Current alarm
Parameter No.0
Parameter No.20
Parameter No.50
Last alarm
Parameter No.1
Parameter No.21
Parameter No.51
Output (DO) signal forced output Test operation mode Jog feed
UP
DOWN
Parameter No.18 Parameter No.48 Parameter No.83
Parameter No.19
Parameter No.49
Parameter No.84
Regenerative load ratio [%] Effective load ratio [%] Peak load ratio [%]
Automatic VC offset
Motor series ID
Motor type ID
Encoder ID
Note. The initial status display at power-on depends on the control mode. Speed control mode: Servo Motor speed(r), Torque control mode: Torque command voltage (U) Also, parameter No.18 can be used to change the initial indication of the status display at power-on.
15 - 55
15.5.2 Status display (1) Status display list The following table lists the servo statuses that may be shown.
Name Cumulative feedback pulses Symbol C Unit pulse Description Feedback pulses from the servo motor encoder are counted and displayed. The value in excess of 99999 is counted, bus since the servo amplifier display is five digits, it shows the lower five digits of the actual value. Press the "SET" button to reset the display value to zero. Reverse rotation is indicated by the lit decimal points in the upper four digits. The servo motor speed is displayed. The value rounded off is displayed in 0.1r/min. (1) Torque control mode Analog speed limit (VLA) voltage is displayed. (2) Speed control mode Analog speed command (VC) voltage is displayed. (1) Speed control mode Analog torque limit (TLA) voltage is displayed. (2) Torque control mode Analog torque command (TLA) voltage is displayed. L The ratio of regenerative power to permissible regenerative power is displayed in . The continuous effective load torque is displayed. The effective value in the past is seconds is displayed relative to the rated torque of 100 . The maximum torque generated during acceleration/deceleration, etc. The highest value in the past 15 seconds is displayed relative to the rated torque of 100 . Torque that occurred instantaneously is displayed. The value of the torque that occurred is displayed in real time relative to the rate torque of 100 . Position within one revolution is displayed in encoder pulses. The value returns to "0" when it exceeds the maximum number of pulses. The value is incremented in the CCW direction of rotation. The within one-revolution position is displayed in 100 pulse increments of the encoder. The value returns to "0" when it exceeds the maximum number of pulses. The value is incremented in the CCW direction of rotation. Display range 99999 to 99999
r/min
Analog speed command voltage Analog speed limit voltage Analog torque command voltage Analog torque limit voltage
5400 to 5400 10.00 to 10.00 0 to 10V 8.0 to 8.0 0 to 100 0 to 300 0 to 400 0 to 400 0 to 99999 0 to 1310 0.0 to 300.0 0 to 450
Instantaneous torque
Cy1
pulse
Cy2
100 pulse
dC
Multiplier The estimated ratio of the load inertia moment to the servo motor shaft ( 1) inertia moment is displayed. V The voltage (across P-N) of the main circuit converter is displayed.
Bus voltage
Pn
15 - 56
(2) Changing the status display screen The status display item of the servo amplifier display shown at power-on can be changed by changing the parameter No.18 settings. The item displayed in the initial status changes with the control mode as follows.
Control mode Speed Speed/torque Torque Status display at power-on Servo motor speed Servo motor speed/analog torque command voltage Analog torque command voltage
15 - 57
Jog feed
Motor-less operation
Indicates the system number of the software. If offset voltages in the analog circuits inside and outside the servo amplifier cause the servo motor to rotate slowly at the analog speed command (VC) or analog speed limit (VLA) of 0V, this function automatically makes zero-adjustment of offset voltages. When using this function, make it valid in the following procedure. Making it valid causes the parameter No.29 value to be the automatically adjusted offset voltage. 1) Press "SET" once. 2) Set the number in the first digit to 1 with "UP"/"DOWN". 3) Press "SET". You cannot use this function if the input voltage of VC or VLA is 0.4V or more.
Automatic VC offset
15 - 58
Display
Description Press the "SET" button to show the motor series ID of the servo motor currently connected.
Motor type ID
Press the "SET" button to show the motor type ID of the servo motor currently connected.
Encoder ID
Press the "SET" button to show the encoder ID of the servo motor currently connected.
15 - 59
15.5.4 External I/O signal display The ON/OFF states of the digital I/O signals connected to the servo amplifier can be confirmed. (1) Operation Call the display screen shown after power-on. Using the "MODE" button, show the diagnostic screen.
CN1 11
The 7-segment LED shown above indicates ON/OFF. Each segment at top indicates the input signal and each segment at bottom indicates the output signal. The signals corresponding to the pins in the respective control modes are indicated below.
CN1 Pin No. 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 21 Input/Output (Note 1) I/O I I I I I I O O O O O (Note 2) Signal abbreviation S ST1 SON ST2 LSP LSN EMG ALM SA RD ZSP OP RD ZSP OP EMG ALM 49 49 49 49 T RS2 SON RS1 Related parameter No. 43 to 47 43 to 47 43 to 47 43 to 48 43 to 48
Note 1. I: Input signal, O: Output signal 2. S: Speed control mode, T: Torque control mode. 3. CN1B-4 and CN1A-18 output signals are the same.
15 - 60
Lit: ON Extinguished: OFF RD (CN 1-11) Ready SA (CN 1-10) Limiting speed ZSP (CN 1-12) Zero speed ALM (CN 1-9) Trouble OP (CN 1-21) Encoder Z-phase pulse
Lit: ON Extinguished: OFF RD (CN 1-11) Ready (CN 1-10) ZSP (CN 1-12) Zero speed ALM (CN 1-9) Trouble OP (CN 1-21) Encoder Z-phase pulse
15 - 61
15.6. Troubleshooting 15.6.1 Trouble at start-up The following faults may occur at start-up. If any of such faults occurs, take the corresponding action. (1) Speed control mode
No. 1 Start-up sequence Power on (Note) Fault LED is not lit. LED flickers. Investigation Not improved if connectors CN1, CN2 and CN3 are disconnected. Improved when connectors CN1 is disconnected. Improved when connector CN2 is disconnected. Possible cause 1. Power supply voltage fault 2. Servo amplifier is faulty. Reference
Alarm occurs. Alarm occurs. Servo motor shaft is not servo-locked (is free).
Gain adjustment
Large load inertia moment causes the servo motor shaft to oscillate side to side.
Power supply of CN1 cabling is shorted. 1. Power supply of encoder cabling is shorted. 2. Encoder is faulty. Improved when connector Power supply of CN3 cabling is CN3 is disconnected. shorted. Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. 1. Servo-on (SON) is not input. 1. Check the display to see if (Wiring mistake) the servo amplifier is ready 2. 24VDC power is not supplied to operate. to COM. 2. Check the external I/O signal indication to see if the servo-on (SON) is ON. Call the status display and Analog speed command is 0V. check the input voltage of the analog speed command (VC). Call the external I/O signal LSP, LSN, ST1 or ST2 is off. display and check the ON/OFF status of the input signal. Set value is 0. Check the internal speed commands 1 to 7 (parameters No.8 to 10 72 to 75). Check the internal torque limit Torque limit level is too low as 1 (parameter No.28). compared to the load torque. Torque limit level is too low as When the analog torque limit compared to the load torque. (TLA) is usable, check the input voltage on the status display. Gain adjustment fault Make gain adjustment in the following procedure. 1. Increase the auto tuning response level. 2. Repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning. Gain adjustment fault If the servo motor may be run with safety, repeat acceleration and deceleration several times to complete auto tuning.
Section 6.2
Section 6.6
Chapter 7
Chapter 7
Note. Switch power on again after making sure that the change lamp has turned off completely.
15 - 62
Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. Refer to section 10.2 and remove cause. 1. Servo-on (SON) is not input. Call the external I/O signal (Wiring mistake) display and check the ON/OFF 2. 24VDC power is not supplied status of the input signal. to COM. Call the status display and check the analog torque command (TC). Analog torque command is 0V.
Section 6.2
RS1 or RS2 is off. Call the external I/O signal display and check the ON/OFF status of the input signal. Check the internal speed limits Set value is 0. 1 to 7 (parameters No.8 to 10 72 to 75). Check the analog torque command maximum output (parameter No.26) value. Check the internal torque limit 1 (parameter No.28). Torque command level is too low as compared to the load torque. Set value is 0.
Section 6.6
Note. Switch power on again after making sure that the change lamp has turned off completely.
15 - 63
15.6.2 Alarms and warning list POINT Configure up a circuit which will detect the trouble (ALM) signal and turn off the servo-on (SON) signal at occurrence of an alarm. When a fault occurs during operation, the corresponding alarm or warning is displayed. If any alarm or warning has occurred, refer to section 10.2.2 or 10.2.3 and take the appropriate action. When an alarm occurs, the current circuit between ALM and VIN opens. Set " 1" in parameter No.49 to output the alarm code in ON/OFF status across the corresponding pin and VIN. Warnings (AL.E0 to AL.E9) have no alarm codes. Any alarm code is output at occurrence of the corresponding alarm. In the normal status, the signals available before alarm code setting (CN1-12: ZSP, CN111: RD, CN1-10: SA) are output. After its cause has been removed, the alarm can be deactivated in any of the methods marked in the alarm deactivation column.
(Note 2) Alarm code Display CN1-10 pin CN1-11 pin CN1-12 pin Name Alarm deactivation Press "SET" on Alarm reset Power (RES) current OFF ON signal alarm screen.
AL.10 0 1 0 Undervoltage AL.12 0 0 0 Memory error 1 AL.13 0 0 0 Clock error AL.15 0 0 0 Memory error 2 AL.16 1 0 1 Encoder error 1 AL.17 0 0 0 Board error AL.19 0 0 0 Memory error 3 AL.1A 1 0 1 Motor combination error AL.20 1 1 0 Encoder error 2 AL.24 0 0 1 Main circuit error AL.30 0 1 0 Regenerative error (Note 1) (Note 1) (Note 1) AL.31 0 1 1 Overspeed AL.32 0 0 1 Overcurrent AL.33 0 1 0 Overvoltage AL.37 0 0 0 Parameter error AL.45 1 1 0 Main circuit device overheat AL.46 1 1 0 Servo motor overheat AL.50 1 1 0 Overload 1 (Note 1) (Note 1) (Note 1) AL.51 1 1 0 Overload 2 (Note 1) (Note 1) (Note 1) AL.8A 0 0 0 Serial communication time-out error AL.8E 0 0 0 Serial communication error 88888 0 0 0 Watchdog AL.E0 Excessive regenerative warning Removing the cause of occurrence AL.E1 Overload warning deactivates the alarm AL.E6 Servo emergency stop warning automatically. AL.E9 Undervoltage warning Note 1. Deactivate the alarm about 30 minutes of cooling time after removing the cause of occurrence. 2. 0: off 1: on Warnings Alarms
15 - 64
APPENDIX
App. Change of connector sets to the RoHS compatible products
The following connector sets have been changed to RoHS compliant since September 2006. RoHS compliant and non-RoHS compliant connector sets may be mixed based on availability. Only the components of the connector set that have changed are listed below.
Model MR-ESCBL M-L MR-ESCBL M-H MR-ENECBL M-L Current product Encoder cable (DDK) MS3106B20-29S (Plug) MS3057-12A (Cable clump) Encoder cable (DDK) MS3106A20-29S(D190) (Plug) CE3057-12A-3(D265) (Cable clump) CE02-20BS-S (Back shell) Encoder cable (DDK) MS3106B20-29S (Plug) MS3057-12A (Cable clump) Encoder cable (DDK) MS3106A20-29S (D190) (Plug) CE3057-12A-3 (D265) (Cable clump) CE02-20BS-S (Back shell) Motor power supply connector (DDK) CE05-6A18-10SD-B-BSS (Connector and Back shell) CE3057-10A-1 (D265) (Cable clump) Motor power supply connector (DDK) CE05-6A22-22SD-B-BSS (Connector and Back shell) CE3057-12A-1 (D265) (Cable clump) RoHS compatible product Encoder cable (DDK) D/MS3106B20-29S (Plug) D/MS3057-12A (Cable clump) Encoder cable (DDK) D/MS3106A20-29S(D190) (Plug) CE3057-12A-3-D (Cable clump) CE02-20BS-S-D (Back shell) Encoder cable (DDK) D/MS3106B20-29S (Plug) D/MS3057-12A (Cable clump) Encoder cable (DDK) D/MS3106A20-29S (D190) (Plug) CE3057-12A-3-D (Cable clump) CE02-20BS-S-D (Back shell) Motor power supply connector (DDK) CE05-6A18-10SD-D-BSS (Connector and Back shell) CE3057-10A-1-D (Cable clump) Motor power supply connector (DDK) CE05-6A22-22SD-D-BSS (Connector and Back shell) CE3057-12A-1-D (Cable clump)
MR-ECNS
MR-ENECNS
MR-PWCNS4
MR-PWCNS5
App. - 1
REVISIONS
*The manual number is given on the bottom left of the back cover.
Print data May, 2008 *Manual number SH(NA)030075-A First edition Revision
SH(NA)030075-A
Printed in Japan
This Instruction Manual uses recycled paper. Specifications subject to change without notice.